Fanuc 21i B Parameter Manual 3 PDF Free
Fanuc 21i B Parameter Manual 3 PDF Free
PARAMETER MANUAL
B-6361 OEN/01
• No part of this manual may be reproduced in any form.
• All specifications and designs are subject to change without notice.
In this manual we have tried as much as possible to describe all the various matters.
However, we cannot describe all the matters which must not be done, or which cannot be
done, because there are so many possibilities.
Therefore, matters which are not especially described as possible in this manual should be
regarded as "impossible".
This manual contains the program names or device names of other companies, some of
which are registered trademarks of respective owners. However, these names are not
followed by® or™ in the main body.
B--63610EN/01 PREFACE
PREFACE
NOTE
1 For ease of explanation, the models may be classified as
follows:
T series: 21 i-TB/21 Oi-TB
Mseries: 21i-MB/210i-MB
2 Some functions described in this manual may not be applied
to some products.
For details, refer to the DESCRIPTIONS (B-63522EN).
,rl
PREFACE B--63610EN/01
The table below lists manuals related to MODEL A of Series 2li, Series
210i. In the table, this manual is maked with an asterisk (*).
Table 1 Related manuals
Specification
Manual name
Number
DESCRIPTIONS B-63522EN
CONNECTION MANUAL (HARDWARE) B-63523EN
CONNECTION MANUAL (FUNCTION) B-63523EN-1
OPERATOR'S MANUAL (For Lathe) B-63604EN
OPERATOR'S MANUAL (For Machining Center) B-63614EN
MAINTENANCE MANUAL B-63525EN
PARAMETER MANUAL B-63610EN *
Related to Programming
Macro Compiler/Macro Executor
B-61803E-1
PROGRAMMING MANUAL
C Language Executor PROGRAMMING MANUAL B-62443EN-3
FANUC MACRO COMPILER (For Personal Computer)
B-66102E
PROGRAMMING MANUAL
Manual for CAP (For Lathe)
FANUC Super CAPi T OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63284EN
FANUC Symbol CAPi T OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63304EN
MANUAL GUIDE PROGRAMMING MANUAL B-63343EN
MANUAL GUIDE OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63344EN
Manual for CAP (For Machining Center)
FANUC Super CAPi M OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63294EN
MANUAL GUIDE (For Milling) PROGRAMMING MANUAL B-63423EN
MANUAL GUIDE (For Milling) OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63424EN
PMC
PMC Ladder language PROGRAMMING MANUAL B-61863E
PMC C language PROGRAMMING MANUAL B-61863E-1
Loader control
Loader Control CONNECTION MANUAL B-62443EN-2
Related to Board
PROFIBUS-DP Board OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-62924EN
Ethernet/DATA SERVER Board OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63354EN
DeviceNet Board OPERATOR'S MANUAL B-63404EN
!Hi361 OEN/01 Table of Contents
PREFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p-1
1. DISPLAYING PARAMETERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
4.1 PARAMETERS OF SETIING...................................................... 9
4.2 PARAMETERS OF READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE, REMOTE BUFFER,
DNCl, DNC2, AND M-NET INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
4.2.1 ParametersCommon to all Channels .. .. .. . .. .. .. .. .. . . .. .. .. .. . . . .. .. .. .. . . .. .. .. .. .. 15
4.2.2 Parameters of Channell (I/O CHANNEirO) . . . . .. .. .. . . . . .. .. .. . . . . . .. .. .. . . . . . . .. .. .. 16
4.2.3 Parameters of Channel I (I/O CHANNEL=!) .. .. .. .. .. . . .. .. .. .. . . . .. .. .. .. . . .. .. .. .. .. 17
4.2.4 ParamerersofChannel2(I/OCHANNEL=2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
4.2.5 ParametersofChannel3(I/OCHANNEL=3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
4.3 PARAMETERS OF DNC1/DNC2 INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.4 PARAMETERS OF REMOTE DIAGNOSIS .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 24
4.5 PARAMETERS OF DNCl INTERFACE . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 28
4.6 PARAMETER OF MEMORY CARD INTERFACE . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . 30
4.7 PARAMETERS OF FACTOLINK . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . 31
4.8 PARAMETERS OF DATA SERVER .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 33
4.9 PARAMETERS OF ETHERNET . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 35
4.10 PARAMETERS OF POWER MATE CNC MANAGER . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . 36
4.11 PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROIJINCREMENT SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
4.12 PARAMETERS OF COORDINA1ES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . 46
4.13 PARAMETERS OF STROKE CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . 52
4.14 PARAMETERS OF THE CHUCK AND TAILSTOCK BARRIER (T SERIES) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
4.15 PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 61
4.16 PARAMETERS OF ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
4.17 PARAMETERS OF SERVO........................................................ 88
4.18 PARAMETERS OF DI/DO. .. . . . . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 113
4.19 PARAMETERS OF MDI, DISPLAY, AND EDIT . .. . . . . .. . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . 117
4.20 PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. . . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 144
4.21 PARAMETERS OF PITCH ERROR COMPENSXl'ION . .. .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 153
4.22 PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
4.23 PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSXl'ION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
4.24 PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . .. .. . . . 216
4.24.1 ParameterofCannedCycleforDrilling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
4.24.2 ParameterofThreadCottingCycle.................................................... 222
4.24.3 Parameter of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
4.24.4 ParametersofPeckDrillingCycleofaSmallDiameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
4.25 PARAMETERS OF RIGID TAPPING . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . .. . . . . .. . . . . . .. . . . . . 228
c-1
Table of Contents ~610EN/01
APPENDIX
c-2
B--63610EN/01 1. DISPLAYING PARAMETERS
1
DISPLAYING PARAMETERS
1401
1402
0
0
0
RDR
0
0
JZR
0
0
0
0
LRP
0
DLF
0
RPD
0
HFC
0
•l•l•l•l•I
[SYSTEM l[M~El[ l GRAPH
>
MEM STRT MTN FIN*** 10:02:35
[PARAM] [DGNOS] [ PMC ] [SYSTEM] [ (OPRT)] -...it--- Soft key display
(section select)
(2) The parameter screen consists of multiple pages. Use step (a) or (b)
to display the page that contains the parameter you want to display.
(a) Use the page select key or the cursor move keys to display the de-
sired page.
(b) Enter the data number of the parameter you want to display from
the keyboard, then press the [NO.SRH] soft key. The parameter
page containing the specified data number appears with the cur-
sor positioned at the data number. (The data is displayed in re-
verse video.)
NOTE
If key entry is started with the section select soft keys
displayed, they are replaced automatically by operation
select soft keys including [NO.SRH]. Pressing the [(OPRT)]
soft key can also cause the operation select keys to be
displayed.
- 1 -
2. SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI B-63610EN/01
3. Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys.
>
MDI STOP********* 10:03:02
~ Soft key display
[NO.SRH] [ ON:1 ] [ OFF:O ] [+INPUT] [INPUT]
(section select)
- 2 -
1Hi3610EN/01 2. SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI
>
MDI STOP*** ***~0:03:10
[NO.SRH] [ ON'l ] [ OFF,Q ] [+INPUT] [INPUT]
[Example] Entering 10;20;30;40 and pressing the INPUT key assigns values 10, 20,
30, and 40 to parameters in order starting at the parameter indicatedby the
cursor.
(6) Repeat steps (4) and (5) as required.
(7) If parameter setting is complete, set "PARAMETER WRITE=" to 0
on the setting screen to disable further parameter setting.
(8) Reset the NC to release the alarm condition (P/SlOO).
If an alarm condition (P/SOOO PLEASE TURN OFF POWER) occurs
in the NC, turn it off before continuing operation.
- 3 -
3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE B-63610EN/01
3 READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE
- 4 -
3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
1Hi3610EN/01 THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE
3.1
(1) Select the EDIT mode or set to Emergency stop.
OUTPUTIING
(2) To select the parameter screen, press the SYSTEM function key as
PARAMETERS many times as required, or alternatively press the SYSTEM function
THROUGH THE key once, then the PARAM section select soft key.
READER/PUNCHER (3) Press the [(OPRnJ soft key to display operation select soft keys, then
INTERFACE press the forward menu key located at the right-hand side of the soft
keys to display another set of operation select keys including
PUNCH.
>
MDI STOP *** ***ALM 10:03:10 ..- State display
[NO.SRH] [ON•ll [OFF•O] [+INPUT] [INPUT] .,._ Solt key display
(operation select)
(4) Pressing the [PUNCH] soft key changes the soft key display as
shown below:
>
EDIT STOP*** *** *** 10:35:03
[ ] [ ] [ ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
(5) Press the [EXEC] soft key to start parameter output. When
parameters are being output, "OUTPUT" blinks in the state display
field on the lower part of the screen.
>
EDIT STOP*** *** *** 10:35:04 OUTPUT <-- OUTPUT blinking
[ ] [ ] [ ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
- 5 -
3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE 1Hi3610EN/01
(5) Pressing the [READ] soft key changes the soft key display as shown
below:
>
EDIT STOP aJ::ll:IC!l) 10' 37 ,30
[ ] [ ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
(6) Press the [EXEC] soft key to start inputting parameters from the
input/output device. When parameters are being input, "INPUT''
blinks in the state display field on the lower part of the screen.
>
EDIT STOP ID:lJ:llfl!!:J10,37,30 INPUT <-- INPUT blinking
[ ] [ ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
(7) When parameter input terminates, "INPUT'' stops blinking. Press the
RESET key to interrupt parameter input.
(8) When parameter read terminates, "INPUT" stops blinking, and an
alarm condition (P/SOOO) occurs in the NC. Turn it off before
continuing operation.
- 6 -
B--63610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4 DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 For the bit type and bit axis type parameters, a single data
number is assigned to 8 bits. Each bit has a different
meaning.
2 The axis type allows data to be set separately for each
control axis.
3 The valid data range for each data type indicates a general
range. The range varies according to the parameters. For
the valid data range of a specific parameter, see the
explanation of the parameter.
(2) Notation of parameters other than bit type and bit axis type
I 1023 I ~l~~~~~~s_ew_o_~_i_s_nu_m_be_r_m_a_s_peci_·_fic_~_i_s~~~~~---'
"-----v--' ~~~~~~~~~~---v'~~~~~~~~~~
- 7 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 The bits left blank in 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
and parameter numbers that appear on the display but are
not found in the parameter list are reserved for future
expansion. They must always be 0.
2 Parameters having different meanings between the T series
and M series and parameters that are valid only for the T or
M series are indicated in two levels as shown below.
Parameters left blank are unavailable.
Example1
Parameter 501 O has different meanings for the T series
and M series.
B5010
Tool nose radius compensation ...
>--------------------<
~-----To_o_lco_m_p_e_nsa_t_io_nc_···-----~ M series
Example2
T series
Example3
The following parameter is provided only for the M series.
~~-----------------11
L:J. F1 digit feed... . TMseserlneess
- 8 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.1 #7
PARAMETERS OF I 0000 I l~-~--~s_E_a~--~-~-1N_1~_1s_o~_rv_c~
SETTING
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] Bit
TVC TVcheck
0 : Not perfonned
1 : Performed
ISO Code used for data output
0: EIAcode
1: ISO code
INI Unit of input
0: Inmm
1 : In inches
SEQ Automatic insertion of sequence numbers
0: Not perfonned
1: Perfonned
NOTE
When a program is prepared by using MDI keys in the part
program storage and edit mode, a sequence number can
automatically be assigned to each block in set increments.
Set the increment to parameter 3216.
#7 #6 #1 #0
~ 11----+--t---cP=R=B-+--+----+--+-=:~=~,---+----J
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] Bit
FCV Tape format
0: Series 21 standard format (Series 16/18--eompatible format is used.)
1: Series 10/11 format
NOTE
1 Programs created in the Series 10/11 tape format can be
used for operation on the following functions:
1) Subprogram call M98
2) Thread cutting with equal leads G32 (T series)
3) Canned cycle G90, G92, G94 (T series)
4) Multiple repetitive canned cycle G71 to G76 (T series)
5) Drilling canned cycle G73, G74, G76, G80 to G89 (M
series)
6) Cutter compensation C (M series)
2 When the tape format used in the Series 10/11 is used for
this CNC, some limits may add. Refer to the Series
21i/210i-MODEL B OPERATOR'S MANUAL.
- 9 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 This parameter has the same function as the probe
attachment signal PRBST<G006#5>.
If the machine has ladder and switch for operating the probe
attachment signal PRBST<G006#5>, set this parameter to
O to protect against incorrect operations.
2 Set this parameter as follows:
- Before attaching a probe connector, turn off the power
to the CNC. After attaching the probe connector, turn on
the power, and then set this parameter to 1.
- Before detaching the probe connector, set this
parameter to 0, and then turn off the power to the CNC.
Note
SJZ is enabled when bit 3 (HJZ) of parameter No.1005 is
set to 1. When a reference position is set without a dog,
(i.e. when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1 002 is set to 1 or
bit 1 (DLZX) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) reference
position return after reference position setting is
performed using rapid traverse at all times, regardless of
the setting of SJZ.
- 10 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0012 RMVx AIC MIRx
RMVx MIRx
NOTE
RMVx is valid when RM Bx in parameter 1005#7 is 1.
L.::.J ~11_o_c_H_A-NN_E_L_:
r-;;l _theforeground -S-ele_ct_io_n_o_f•_n_in_p_uV_o_ut-pu_1_devi-·ce_o_r_••_l•_cti_·o_n_o_fi_np_u_td-ev-ice-in~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 35
I/O CHANNEL: Selection of the input/output device to be used
The CNC provides the following interfaces for data transfer to and from
the host computer and external input/output devices:
• Input/output device interface (RS-232C serial port 1, 2)
• Remote buffer interface (RS-232C/RS-422)
• Memory card interface
• DNC1/DNC2 interface
Data can be transferred to and from a personal computer connected via the
FOCASl/Ethernet or FOCASl/HSSB.
In addition, data can be transferred to and from the Power Mate via the
FANUC I/O Link.
This parameter selects the interface used to transfer data to and from an
input/output device.
- 11 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Setting Description
0, 1 RS-232C serial port 1
2 RS-232C serial port 2
3 Remote buffer interface
4 Memory card interface
5 Data server interface
6 The DNC operation is performed or M198 is specified by FOCAS1/
Ethernet or DNC1 /Ethernet.
10 DNC1/DNC2 interface
12 DNC1 interface #2
15 M198 is specified by FOCAS1/HSSB. (Bit 1 (NWD) of parameter
No. 8706) must also be specified.)
.I
16 The DNC operation is performed or M198 is specified by FOCAS1/
HSSB (port 2).
20
21
22
I
·~I
Group 1
Group 2 Data is transferred between the CNC and a Power
Mate in group n (n: 0 to 15) via the FANUC 1/0 Link.
34 Group 14
35 Grouo 15
Supplemental remark 1
If the DNC operation is performed with FOCASl/HSSB, the setting
of parameter No. 20 does not matter. The DMMC signal <G042.7>
is used.
Supplemental remark 2
If bit 0 (I04) of parameter No. ll 0 is set to control the I/O channels
separately, the I/O channels can be divided into four types: input and
output in the foreground and input and output in the background. If
so, parameter No. 20 becomes a parameter for selecting the input
device in the foreground.
- 12 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 An inpuVoutput device can also be selected using the setting screen. Usually, the setting screen
is used.
2 The specifications (such as the baud rate and the number of stop bits) of the inpuVoutput
devices to be connected must be set in the corresponding parameters for each interface
beforehand. (See Section 4.2.) 1/0 CHANNEL= Oand 1/0 CHANNEL= 1 represent inpuVoutput
devices connected to RS-232C serial port 1. Separate parameters for the baud rate, stop bits,
and other specifications are provided for each channel.
Motherboard
R422-1 (JD6A)
OD 1/0 CHANNEL.-3
(Channel3) D RS-4221/0 device
(when a remote buffer or DNC1 board is used)
NOTE
If different inpuVoutput devices are simultaneously used in
the foreground and background, just a value from 0 to 3 can
be specified for the background device.
If an attempt is made to use a busy inpuVoutput device, an
alarm (P/S233 or BP/S233) will be raised. Note that the
settings 0 and 1 indicate the same inpuVoutput device.
- 13 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.2 This CNC has three channels of input/output device interfaces. The
input/output device to be used is specified by setting the channel
PARAMETERS OF connected to that device in setting parameter I/O CHANNEL.
READER/PUNCHER The specified data, such as a baud rate and the number of stop bits, of an
INTERFACE, REMOTE input/output device connected to a specific channel must be set in
parameters for that channel in advance.
BUFFER, DNC1,
For channel 1, two combinations of parameters to specify the input/output
DNC2, AND M-NET device data are provided.
INTERFACE The following shows the interrelation between the input/output device
interface parameters for the channels.
1/0 CHANNEL
1/0 CHANNEL=O
(channel 1)
{ 0102
0103
Number specified for the input/
output device
Baud rate
0113
Number specified for the input/
output device
Baud rate
0123
Number specified for the input/
output device
Baud rate
- 14 -
B--63610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.2.1
Parameters Common
to all Channels 0024 I I Port for communication with the PMC ladder development tool (FANUC LADDER-111111) I
[Data type] Byte
This parameter sets the port to be used for communication with the PMC
ladder development tool (FANUC LADDER-II/Ill).
0 : HSSB (COP7)
1 : RS-232C serial port 1 (JD36A)
2 : RS-232C serial port 2 (JD36B)
3 : Remote buffer interface (RS-232C) (JD28A)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 0100 I I. . ._E_N_s..........._1o_P__._N_D_3..........._ _..........._Nc_R__._c_R_F..........._CTV
_ ___.__ _.....
NOTE
In general, reading is performed more efficiently when ND3
set to 1. This specification reduces the number of buffering
interruptions caused by reading of a series of blocks
specifying short movements. This in turn reduces the
effective cycle time.
- 15 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
ENS Action taken when a NULL code is found during read of EIA code
0 : An alarm is generated.
1 : The NULL code is ignored.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0110 1 1~-~--~--~-~--~--~-~-10_4~
[Data type] Bit
104 Separate control of I/O channel nwnbers is:
0: Not performed.
1: Performed.
If the I/O channels are not separately controlled, set the input/output
device in parameter No. 20.
If the I/O channels are separately controlled, set the input device and
output device in the foreground and the input device and output device in
the background in parameters No. 20 to No. 23 respectively.
Separate control ofl/O channels makes it possible to perform background
editing, program input/output, and the like during the DNC operation.
4.2.2
Parameters of
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Channel 1 0101 NFD ASI SB2
(1/0 CHANNEL:O) NFD ASI HAD SB2
NOTE
When inpuVoutput devices other than the FANUC PPR
are used, set NFD to 1.
0102 II Nurrber specffied for the inpuVoutput device (when the liO CHANNEL is set ID 0)
- 16 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
0103 I ~l_____B_a_ud_ra_re_(wh_e_n_t_he_v_o_c_H_AN_N_EL_i_ss_m_t_o_Ol_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
Set baud rate of tbe input/output device used when tbe I/O CHANNEL is
set to 0, witb a set value in Table 4.2 (b).
lllble 4.2.2 bl
Sat value Baud rate (bps) Sat value Baud rate (bps)
1 50 7 600
2 100 8 1200
3 110 9 2400
4 150 10 4800
5 200 11 9600
6 300 12 192nn
4.2.3
Parameters of
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1
Channel 1 ASI SB2
.__01_11__,I I NFD
(1/0 CHANNEL=1)
[Data type] Bit
These parameters are used when I/O CHANNEL is set to 1. The meanings
of tbe bits are tbe same as for parameter 0101.
I 0112 I I Number specified for the input/output device (when VO CHANNEL is set to 1)
- 17 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.2.4
Parameters of
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Channel2 ~01_2_1~I I NFD ASI SB2
(1/0 CHANNEL=2)
[Data type] Bit
These parameters are used when I/O CHANNEL is set to 2. The meanings
of the bits are the same as for parameter 0101.
I 0122 II Number specified for the input/output device (when 1/0 CHANNEL is set to 2)
I 0123 I ~l_____B_a_ud_r_fil_•_(wh_e_n_th_e_v_o_c_HAN_N_E_L_is_sffi_ro_2l_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
Set the baud rate of the input/output device used when I/O CHANNEL is
set to 2, with a value in Table 4.2 (b).
4.2.5
Parameters of
Channel3 0131 I l~N_F_D~--~--~-~-AS_l~--~--~-S-B2~
(1/0 CHANNEL:3)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
0132 II Number specified for the input/output device (when 1/0 CHANNEL is set to 3)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 18 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
0133 I ~I_____B_a_ud_r_ate_(wh_e_n_th_e_v_o_c_HAN_N_E_L_is_set_to_3l_ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
Set value Baud rate (bps) Set value Baud rate (bps)
1 50 9 2400
2 100 10 4800
3 110 11 9600
4 150 12 19200
5 200 13 38400
6 300 14 76800
7 600 14 86400
8 1200
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0134 I l.___ _,____,__c_LK_.__N_c_a_,__ __,__s_vN_.__P_RY_ _.__ __,
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
When the RS-232C interface is used, set this bit to 0.
- 19 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
0135 II RMS R42 PAA ETX ASC
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
Use of ASCII/ISO is specified by ASC.
~ #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ #0
NOTE
Use a PCMCIA card attachment suited to the CNC to secure
the memory card in the CNC.
- 20 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.3
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAMETERS OF
0140 I l.___ _,____,___.___ _,__Ec_o___._N_c_E_.__ __.__sc_c___.
DNC1/DNC2
INTERFACE NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
To use FANUC DNC2 communications library for the host
computer, set this parameter to 1.
0141 I ~I__s_ys_1e_m_fo_r_oo_n_ne_ct_io_n_betwe
__ •n_t_he_c_N_c_a_nd_h_ost_(D_N_c1_i_n1_er1a_ce_)-~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
I 0142 I ~I_____s_1a1_io_n_ad_d_res_s_o_ft_he_C_N_C_(D_N_c_1_in_1e_rta_ce_J_ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 21 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
I 0143 I ~I__TI_1m_e_li_m_its_pe_c_ifi_e_d_fo_rt_he_t_im_e_rm_o_n_ito_ri_ng_a_res_p_on_se_(D_N_c_2_int_e_rta_ce_)_~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
I 0144 II lime limit specified for the timer monitoring the EQT signal (DNC2 interface)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
I 0145 I ~l___TI_m_e_re_qu_ired_f_or_sw_1tc_hi_ng_R_E_c_v_a_nd_S_E_N_D_(D_N_c_2_in_re_rta_ce_)_ _~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
I 0146 II Number of times the system retries holding communication (DNC2 interface)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 22 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ ~N_u_m_be_r_of_ti_m_es_1_he_s_ys_1e_m_se_nd_s_th_e_m_es_sag_e_in_r_e_sp_o_ns_e_to_t_he_N_A_K_s_ig-na_1~
L.:::_J _ (DNC2 intertace)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
I 0148 I ~l_____N_um_be_ro_f_ch_a_ra_m_era_in_o_ve_rr_un_(_D_N_C2_)_in_te_rt_ace_)_ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 23 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.4
PARAMETERS OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
REMOTE 0002 I l.___ _.___~-~--~--'---.._----L_RD_G~
DIAGNOSIS [Data type] Bit
RDG Remote diagnosis is:
0: Not performed.
1: Performed.
If an RS-232C serial port is used to carry out remote diagnosis, connect
and set up the modem, cable, and the like, then set 1 in this parameter.
When using a modem card, the setting is not necessary.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ ~
- 24 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
When using a modem card (when bit 6 (MCB) of parameter No. 201 is
set to 1)
Setting Baud rate (bps) Setting Baud rate (bps)
1 28800 7 600
2 38400 8 1200
3 57600 9 2400
4 - 10 4800
5 - 11 9600
6 300 12 19200
NOTE
The tables above indicate the baud rates of communication
between the CNC and modem. The actual communication
baud rate may be lowered, depending on the modem and
communication line.
0204 I ~l________R_e_m_01_e_di_ag_n_os_is_c_ha_n_ne_1_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0, l, 2
The interface to be used for remote diagnosis is:
0, 1: RS-232C serial port 1 (channel 1).
2 : RS-232C serial port 2 (channel 2).
To carry out remote diagnosis using RS-232C, the reader/punch interface
is required.
- 25 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
0211 I ~I_______Passw
__o_rd_1_f_or_re_m_o_te_d_iag_n_o_si_s------~
0212 I ~l_______Passwo
_ _rd_2_1_or_~_m_o_te_d_iag_n_o_si_•_ _ _ _ _ __,
0213 I ~l_______Passw
__o_rd_3_ro_r_re_m_m_e_d_iag_n_o_si_s_ _ _ _ _ __,
NOTE
Once any value other than 0 is specified as a password, the
password can be changed only when the same value is
specified in the corresponding keyword (parameters No. 221
to No. 223). If any value other than 0 is specified as a
password, the password setting is not displayed on the
parameter screen (blank display is provided). Take great
care when setting the password.
- 26 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
0221 I ~I_______K_eywo
__ rd_1_fo_r_re_m_ot_e_di_ag_n_os_is_ _ _ _ _ _~
0223 I ~l_______K_eywo
__ ro_3_ro_r_re_m_m_e_di_ag_n_os_is_ _ _ _ _ ___,
NOTE
The keyword value is reset to 0 at power-up.
On the parameter screen, the keyword setting is not
displayed (blank display is provided).
- 27 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.5
PARAMETERS OF
DNC1 INTERFACE 0231 I l~N_F_D~--~--~-~-A_Sl~--~--~-S_B2~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
[Data type]
SB2 Number of stop bits
0: 1 bit
1: 2 bits
ASI Data input code
0: IBA or ISO (automatic recognition)
1: ASCII Code
NFD When data is out, feed holes are
0: Output before and after data section
I: Not output
I 0233 I ~I_______Ba_ud_ra_te_(D_N_c_1i_nte_ri_ace_#2_l_ _ _ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
0241 I ~I__M_o_de_o_fco_nn_ec1_i_on_b_etw_••_n_1h_•_hos_1a_nd_C_N_C_(_DN_c_1_1n_1e_rta_ce_#2_)_~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 28 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 29 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.6
PARAMETER OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
MEMORY CARD 0300 I l.___ _,_ __ _,_ __ .___ _,_ __ _,_ __ .___ _,__PC_M__,
- 30 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.7
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
FACTOLINK
0801 I l~-~--~--~-~--~--~-~-S_B2~
[Data type] Bit
SB2 The number of stop bits is:
O:lbit.
1 : 2 bits.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ ~
I 0810 I l~-~--~-F_M_N~_FT_M~_FY_R~_F_c_L~_F_A_s~_sa_s~
[Data type] Bit
BGS When the FACTOLINK screen is not displayed, FACTOLINKalarm task
communication is:
0 : Not activated.
1 : Activated.
FAS 1f FACTOLlNK uses the Answer or AnswerEx command, the answer
number AOL is:
0: Displayed in the answer field.
1: Not displayed in the answer field.
FCL The FACTOLlNK clock is:
0: Not displayed in reverse video.
1: Displayed in reverse video.
FYR In the FACTOLINK clock display, years in the 99/01/23 00:00 format (bit
4 (FTM) of parameter No. 810 set to 1) are represented:
0: By a two-digit number.
1: By a four--<ligit number.
FTM The FACTOLlNK clock is displayed in this format:
0: Wed Nov 12 00:00:00
1: 97/11112 00:00:00
FMN The FACTOLlNK screen is displayed:
0: Incolor.
1: With two levels of gray.
I 0811 I ~I_______Lo_g_gi_ng_typ_e_ro_rt_he_F_AC_TO_L_IN_K_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
- 31 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 32 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.8
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
DATA SERVER 0000 I l~-~--~--~-~--~--~o_N_s~_os_v~
[Data type] Bit
DSV The data server function is
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
ONS When the 0 number of the data server file name and the 0 number in an
NC program do not match:
0: The 0 number of the file name takes priority.
1: The 0 number in the NC program takes priority.
I 0911 I ~I________A_lt_em_a_te_M_D_Ic_ha_ract_e_r-------~
[Data type] Word
[Set value] ASCII code (decimal)
I 0912 I ~I______c_h_ar_act_e_rn_o_tp_ro_vi_ded_i_nM_D_l_k•_Y_•-----~
[Data type] Word
[Set value] ASCII code (decimal)
When specifying a character which is not provided as a MDI keys for
HOST DIRECTORY of DATA SERVER SETTING-I, use these
parameters to assign an alternative key to that character.
NOTE
When both parameters No.0911 and 0912 are set to 0, the
data server assumes the following setting:
No.0911 = 32 (blank)
No.0912 = 92 (\)
- 33 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 34 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.9
PARAMETERS OF
ETHERNET 0931 I ~I___s_pe_ci_al_ch_a_ra_cte_r_c_od_e_c_or_re_sp_o_nd_in_g_to_s_o_tt_ke_y_[C_H_A_R_-1_1_ _~
0932 I ~I___s_pe_ci_al_ch_a_racte_r_c_od_e_c_or_res_p_o_nd_i_ng_to_s_ott_ke_y_[C_H_A_R_-2_]_ _~
0933 I ~I___s_pe_ci_a1_ch_a_ra_ct_er_c_od_e_c_or_res_p_o_nd_i_ng_to_s_o_ft_ke_y_IC_H_A_R_-3_J_ _~
0934 I ~I___s_pe_ci_al_ch_a_racte_r_c_od_e_co_r_res_p_o_nd_i_ng_to_s_ott_ke_Y_IC_H_A_R_-4_1_ _~
0935 I ~I___s_pe_ci_a1_ch_a_ra_c1e_r_c_od_e_c_or_res_p_o_nd_i_ng_to_s_ott_ke_y_[C_H_A_R_-s_1_ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 32 to 95
These parameters are provided to allow a special character that is not
provided on the MDI panel but needed in a user name, password, or login
DIR to be input by pressing a soft key on the Ethernet parameter screen.
If a value other than 0 is input as a parameter, the special character
assigned to the corresponding input soft key [CHAR-I] to [CHAR-5] is
displayed.
The special character codes correspond to the ASCII codes.
Sample special character codes
Special Code Special Code Special Code
character character character
Blank 32 ) 41 < 60
I 33 • 42 > 62
" 34 + 43 ? 63
# 35 '
44 @ 64
$ 36 - 45 [ 91
% 37 46 A
92
& 38 I 47 ¥ 93
39 58 I 94
( 40 ; 59 - 95
- 35 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.10
PARAMETERS OF
POWER MATE CNC #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
MANAGER 0950 I l~~~~~~~~~~~~PM_N~~M_o_2~_M_o_1~~s_LV~
[Data type] Bit
SLV When the power mate CNC manager is selected, the screen displays:
0 : One slave.
1 : Up to four slaves with the screen divided into four.
MD1,MD2 These parameters set a slave parameter input/output destination.
- 36 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.11
PARAMETERS OF
AXIS CONTROU
INCREMENT SYSTEM #? #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #o
~I-,00-1~1 l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-IN_M~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
1 This function can be specified for each axis by DLZX, bit 1 of
parameter No.1005.
2 For a system including an axis of Cs contour control or
spindle positioning, avoid using this parameter. Use bit 1
(DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 instead to set just a required
axis.
NOTE
When reference position return without dogs is specified,
(when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1002 is set to 1 or bit 1
(DLZx) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) the G28 command
specified before a reference position is set causes PIS
alarm No.090 to be issued, regardless of the setting of AZR.
- 37 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
IS-A cannot be used at present.
I
IPR Whether the least input increment for each axis is set to a value 10 times as
large as the least command increment is specified, in increment systems
of IS-B or IS-C at setting mm.
0: The least input increment is not set to a value 10 times as larg as the
least command increment.
1: The least input increment is set to a value 10 times as large as the least
command increment.
If IPR is set to 1, the least input increment is set as follows:
Input increment Least input increment
1$-B O.o1 mm, 0.01 deg, or 0.0001 inch
IS-C 0.001 mm, 0.001 deg, or 0.00001 inch
NOTE
For IS-A, the least input increment cannot be set to a value
1O times as large as the least command increment.
The least input increment is not multiplied by 1O also when
the calculator-type decimal point input (bit 0 (DPI) of
parameter No. 3401) is used.
- 38 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
r-::::-1
~
RMBx MCCx EDMx EDPx DLZx ZRNx
>--R-M-Bx--+-M-C_Cx___.~ED_M_x-+--E-D-Px--+~HJ-Zx---<~~-+--D-LZx~-+-Z-R_N_x~
NOTE
1 The state in which the reference position has not been
established refers to that state in which reference position
return has not been performed after power-on when an
absolute posnion detector is not being used, or that state in
which the association of the machine position wtth the position
detected wnh the absolute position detector has not been
completed (see the description of btt 4 (APZX) of parameter
No. 1815) when an absolute position detector is being used.
2 To use a function that establishes the reference point and
makes a movement with a command other than G28, such
as an axis of Cs contour control, set this parameter for the
relative axis.
NOTE
1 When DLZ of parameter No.1002 is 0, DL.Zx is enabled.
When DLZ of parameter No.1002 is 1, DLZX is disabled, and
the function for setting the reference position without dogs
is enabled for all axes.
2 Avoid setting this parameter for an axis of Cs contour control
or spindle positioning.
NOTE
When reference position return without dogs is specified,
(when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1002 is set to 1 or bit
(DL.Zx) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) reference position
return after a reference position is set is performed using
rapid traverse, regardless of the setting of HJZ.
EDPx External deceleration signal in the positive direction for each axis
0 : Valid only for rapid traverse
1 : Valid for rapid traverse and cutting feed
- 39 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EDMx External deceleration signal in the negative direction for each axis
0 : Valid only for rapid traverse
1 : Valid for rapid traverse and cutting feed
MCCx When an axis become the removal state using the controlled axis removal
signal or setting:
0: MCC is turned off
1: MCC is not turned off. (Servo motor excitation is turned off, but the
MCC signal of the servo amplifier is not turned off.)
NOTE
This parameter is used to remove only one axis, for example,
when a two-axis or three-axis amplifier is used. When
two-a axis or three-axis amplifier is used and only one axis
is removed, servo alarm No.401 (V-READY OFF) is usually
issued. However, this parameter, when set to 1, prevents
servo alarm No.401 from being issued.
Note, however, that disconnecting a servo amplifier from the
CNC will cause the servo amplifier to enter the V-READY
OFF status. This is a characteristic of all multiaxis amplifiers.
RMBx Releasing the assignment of the control axis for each axis (signal input
and setting input)
0: Invalid
1: Valid
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1t--~--+~~-+--z_M_1_x-+-~~-+--D-IAx~+-~~t--R_o_sx--+~RO_T_x_,
L:_J . ZMlx ROSx ROTx
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 40 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
DIAx Either a diameter or radius is set to be used for specifying the amount of
travel on each axis.
0: Radius
I: Diameter
ZMix The direction of reference position return.
0 : Positive direction
I : Negative direction
NOTE
The direction of the initial backlash, which occurs when
power is switched on, is opposite to the direction of a
reference position return.
#7 1#6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1oos II RAAx RRLx RABx ROAx
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
ROAx specifies the function only for a rotation axis (for which
ROTx, #0 of parameter No.1006, is set to 1)
NOTE
RABx is valid only when ROAx is 1.
- 41 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 RRLx is valid only when ROAx is 1.
2 Assign the amount of the shift per one rotation in parameter
No.1260.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
Examples Suppose that the first axis is the X axis, and the second and subsequent
axes are the Y, Z, and A axes in that order, and that they are controlled as
follows:
X, Y, and Z axes: Controlled by the CNC
A axis: Controlled by the PMC
Then set this parameter to 3 (total 3: X, Y, and Z)
With this setting, the fifth axis (A axis) is controlledonlybythePMC, and
therefore cannot be controlled directly by the CNC.
- 42 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 IDGx is enabled when the IDG parameter (bit 7 of parameter
No. 1002) is 1.
2 When the function for setting the reference position, without
dogs, is used, and the reference position is lost for some
reason, an alarm requesting reference position return
(No.300) is generated when the power is next turned on. If
the operator performs reference position return, as a result
of mistakenly identifying the alarm as that requesting the
operator to perform a normal reference position return, an
invalid reference position may be set. To prevent such an
operator error, the IDGx parameter is provided to preventthe
reference position from being set again without dogs.
(1) If the IDG parameter (bit 7 of parameter No.1002) is set
to 1, the IDGx parameter (bit O of parameter No.1012)
is automatically set to 1 when the reference position is
set using the function for setting the reference position
without dogs. This prevents the reference position from
being set again without dogs.
(2) Once the reference position is prevented from being set
for an axis again, without dogs, any attempt to set the
reference position for the axis without dogs results in the
output of an alarm (No.090).
(3) When the reference position must be set again without
dogs, set IDGx to 0 before setting the reference position.
- 43 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 With the T series, when G code system A is used, neither U,
V, nor W can be used as an axis name. Only when G code
system B or C is used, U, V, and W can be used as axis
names.
2 The same axis name cannot be assigned to more than one
axis.
3 When the secondary auxiliary function (option) is provided,
the address used by the secondary auxiliary function
(address B with the T series or, with the M series, the address
specified in parameter No.3460) cannot be used as an axis
name.
4 With the T series, when address C or A is used for
chamfering, corner rounding, or direct drawing dimension
programming (when the CCR parameter (bit 4 of parameter
No.3405) is set to 1), addresses C or A cannot be used as
an axis name.
5 Only with the T series, address E can be used as an axis
name. Address E cannot be used with the M series. When
address E is used as an axis name, note the following:
- When G code system A is used, address E is always
assigned to an absolute command.
- When an equal-lead threading command (G32) is issued
in the Series 10/11 command format, address E cannot be
used to specify the thread lead. Use address F to specify
the thread lead.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
operation is continued.
- 44 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
operation is continued.
- 45 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.12 #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAMETERS OF WZR AWK FPC ZCL ZPI ZPR
COORDINATES AWK FPC ZCL ZPI ZPR
NOTE
1 ZPR is valid while a workpiece coordinate system function
is not provided. If a workpiece coordinate system function
is provided, making a manual reference position return
always causes the workpiece coordinate system to be
established on the basis of the workpiece origin offset
(parameters No. 1220 to No. 1226), irrespective of this
parameter setting.
2 If an absolute-position coder is used in a system not using
a workpiece coordinate system function, set this parameter.
- 46 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1>--~--+~~-+-~~-+--G-_-+~:-~-~-+-~a_so~>--E_w_s--+~E_w_o_,
52
[Data type] Bit
EWD The shift clirection of the workpiece coordinate system is:
0 : The clirection specified by the external workpiece zero point offset
value
1 : In the opposite direction to that specified by the external workpiece
zero point offset value
x x x x
z Z (Shifted workpiece
coordinate system)
-EXOFS
z z (Original workpiece
coordinate system)
EXOFS : External workpiece zero point offset value
EWS Shift value of the workpiece coordinate system and external workpiece
zero point offset value are
0 : Stored in the separate memory areas.
1 : Stored in the same memory area, that is, the shift and the offset values
are the same.
GSO When the CNC has commands G54 to G59 specifying workpiece
coordinate systems (optional function), if the G50 command for setting a
coordinate system (or the G92 command in G command system B or C) is
specified,
0 : G50 is executed and no alarm is issued.
1 : G50 is not executed and a P/S alarm (No. 010) is issued.
RLC Local coordinate system is
0 : Not cancelled by reset
1 : Cancelled by reset
G52 In local coordinate system setting (G52), a cutter compensation vector is:
0 : Not considered.
I : Considered.
NOTE
Select a local coordinate system setting operation when
cutter compensation is applied, and when two or more
blocks specifying no movement exist prior to the
specification of G52, or when G52 is specified after cutter
compensation mode is canceled without eliminating the
offset vector.
- 47 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1203 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-E_M_C~
[Data type] Bit
EMC The extended external machine zero point shlft function is:
0: Disabled.
1: Enabled.
NOTE
1 To use the extended external machine zero point shift
function, the external machine zero point shift function or the
external data input function is required.
2 When the extended machine zero point shift function is
enabled, the conventional external machine zero point shift
function is disabled.
1220 I ~l~~~~~~E-~_•_rn_a_lwo~~-Pi_ec_e_z_•_~_p_oi_n1_o_ff_set_v_a_1u_e~~~~~--'
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data]
Input Increment IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Linear axis (input in mm) 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Linear axis (input in inches) 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
1221 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 1 (G54)
1222 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 2(G55)
1223 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 3(G56)
1224 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 4 (G57)
1225 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 5 {G58)
1226 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 6 {G59)
- 48 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
The workpiece ongm offset can also be set using the
workpiece coordinate system screen.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
operation is continued.
a Coordinate value of the third reference position on each axis in the machine coor-
dinate system
a Coordinate value of the fourth reference position on each axis in the machine
coordinate system
- 49 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
a
[Data type] 2-word axis
Coordinatevalue of the reference position on each axis used for setting a coordi-
nate system automatically when input is performed in inches
NOTE
This parameter is valid when ZPI in parameter 1201 is set to
1.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 50 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
First address of the signal group used by the external machine zero point shift
extension
R0100
Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the first axis (LOW)
R0101
Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the first axis (HIGH)
R0102 Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the second axis (LOW)
R0103 Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the second axis (HIGH)
R0114
Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the eighth axis (LOW)
R0115
Shift amount of external machine zero point shift extension for
the eighth axis (HIGH)
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid when bit 0 (EMC) of parameter No.
1203 is set to 1.
2 If the specified number is not present, the external machine
zero point shift extension is disabled.
3 A shift amount of the external machine zero point shift
extension can be written from the C executer or macro
executer.
B
[Data type] 2-word
Distance between two opposite tool posts in mirror image
[Unit of data]
Increment system ls-A 15-8 15-C Unit
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
- 51 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.13
PARAMETERS OF
STROKE CHECK ~ ~1-:-:-:--+~~-:---l~R_L.3~+--~--+~~-+--~-~-:--+-~~+--~-~~---l
[Data type] Bit
OUT The area inside or outside of the stored stroke check 2 is set as an
inhibition area (setting by the parameters No.1322 and No.1323).
0: Inside
1: Outside
LMS The EXLM signal for switching stored stroke check
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
NOTE
Stored stroke check 1 supports two pairs of parameters for
setting the prohibited area. The stored stroke limit switching
signal is used to enable either of the prohibited areas set with
these parameter pairs.
(1) Prohibited area I: Parameters No.1320 and No.1321
(2) Prohibited area 11: Parameters No.1326 and No.1327
NOTE
When an absolute position detector is used and a reference
position is already set upon power-up, stored stroke limit
check 1 is started immediately after power-up, regardless of
the setting.
NOTE
The tool stops at a point up to F/7500 mm short of or ahead
of the boundary.
(F: Feedrate when the tool reaches the boundary (mm/min))
- 52 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
CAUTION
In the cases below, the automatic release function is
disabled. To release an alarm, a reset operation is required.
1 When a setting is made to issue an alarm before a stored
stroke limit is exceeded (bit 7 (BFA) of parameter No.
1300)
2 When an another overtravel alarm (such as stored stroke
check 2, stored stroke check 3, and interference check) is
already issued
3 When an overtravel alarm is already issued with the
high-precision contour control function or the chopping
function in the M series
OTS If a stored stroke limit alarm is raised by setting bit 7 (BFA) of parameter
No. 1300 to l, the axial movement stops:
0: Before the boundary of stored stroke check.
1: On the boundary of stored stroke check.
CAUTION
To enable this parameter, the manual linear/circular
interpolation function is required. If this function is not
provided, this parameter setting is ignored.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
- 53 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
1320 Coordinatevalue I of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis
1321 Coordinate value I of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis
NOTE
1 For axes with diameter specification, a diameter value must
be set.
2 When the parameters are set as follows, the stroke becomes
infinite:
parameter 1320 < parameter 1321
For movement along the axis for which infinite stroke is set,
only increment commands are available. (The stored stroke
limit switching signal also becomes invalid.) If an absolute
command is issued for this axis, the absolute register may
overflow, and normal movement will not result.
3 The prohibited area specified with these parameters is
invalid if bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No. 1300 is set to 1 and
stored stroke limit switching signal EXLM is set to 1. In such
a case, the settings of parameters No. 1326 and 1327 are
used, instead.
- 54 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1322 Coordinatevalue of stored stroke check 2 in the positive direction on each axis
1323 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 in the negative direction on each axis
~ (Xp,Yp,Zp)
(Xm,Ym,Zm)
NOTE
For axes with diameter specification, a diameter value must
be set.
- 55 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
r-:::::-1 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the positive direction on each axis
LJ
l::"l Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the positive direction on each axis
LJ
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
NOTE
Specify diameters for any axis for which diameter
programming is specified.
1326 Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis
1327 Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis
NOTE
1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter
programming is specified.
2 These parameters are invalid if bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No.
1300 is set to 0, or if stored stroke limit switching signal
EXLM is set to 0. In such a case, the settings of parameters
No. 1320 and 1321 are used, instead.
- 56 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.14
PARAMETERS OF
THE CHUCK AND
TAILSTOCK
~ ~1---------P-~_fil_eo_f_a_ch_u_ck_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _----l
BARRIER
(TSERIES) [Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 or 1
0: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner surface
1: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the outer surface
l"::"l
~
Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (L)
>-------------------------!
l::'l
LJ Dimensions of the claw of a chuck {W)
>-------------------------!
l::'l
LJ Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held (L1)
t-------------------------1
r-::::"l
LJ Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held (W1)
t-------------------------1
l":::l
LJ X coordinate of a chuck (CX)
t-------------------------1
1::1
LJ > - - - - - - - -ZX-coordinate of a chuck (CZ)
----------------!
- 57 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Chuck which holds a workpiece on the outer surface Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner surface
(TY= 1) (TY= 0)
x x
L A
A
W1
w w
ex L1 ex
CZ----1'
CZ-I '
Zero point of the ,.-----------, Zero point of the
workpiece workpiece
coodinate system coodinate system
Symbol Decription
Ty Profile of a chuck (0: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner
surface, 1: Chuck which holdsa workpiece on the outer surface)
ex X coordinate of a chuck
CZ Z coordinate of a chuck
L Dimensions of the claw of a chuck
w Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (radius input)
L1 Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held
W1 Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held (ra-
dius input)
NOTE
Specifying the coordinates with a diameter or radius depends
on whether the correspondingaxis conforms to diameter or
radius specification. When the axis conforms to diameter
specnication, spcify the coordinates with a diameter.
NOTE
Always specify W and W1 with radiuses. Specify L and L 1
with radiuses when the Z--axis conforms to radius
specification.
- 58 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
x -L-
-Lt-
TZ
l--L2-
Workpiece
->1_t D1 )
z
/
Zero point of
~ 1
the workpiece
coordinate
system
- 59 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Symbol Description
TZ Z--<1Xis coordinate of a tailstock
L Length of a tailstock
D Diameter of a tailstock (diameter input)
L1 Length of a tailstock (1)
D1 Diameter of a tailstock (1) (diameter input)
L2 Length of a tailstock (2)
D2 Diameter of a tailstock (2) (diameter input)
03 Diameter of the hole of a tailstock (diameter input)
TZ: Specifies the position (point B) of a tailstock with the Z-axis coordinate
of the workpiece coordinate system. In this case, do not use the coordinate
of the machine coordinate system. The profile of a tailstock is assumed to
be symmetrical with respect to the Z-axis.
NOTE
Specifying the position of a tailstock with a radius or diameter
depends on whether the Z-axis conforms to radius or
diameter specification.
NOTE
Always specify 0, 01, 02, and 03 with diameters. Specify L,
L1, and L2 with radiuses if the Z-axis conforms to radius
specification.
- 60 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.15
PARAMETERS OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
FEEDRATE RDR TDR RFO JZR LRP RPD
RDR TDR RFO LRP RPD
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
To use a position coder, set this parameter to 0. While
this parameter is set to 1, threading cannot be performed
even if a position coder is provided.
- 61 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
Specify a feedrate in parameter No.1423.
~ l+--R_TV~+-~--+~~-+-~~+-~--+~~-+-~~+--M_IF--+
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
M series are not equipped with this parameter. Cutting
feedrates are specified by F commands in units of 0.001
mm/min for millimeter machines or 0.00001 inches/min for
inch machines.
#7
~ l+--F-C-0--+-~~-+--:-~-:-+-~~+--::V-v--+~:-::~t--~-~-:--+~H-FC--+
[Data type] Bit
- 62 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
This parameter selects a feedrate for reference position
return performed without dogs. This parameter also selects
a feedrate when manual reference position return is
performed according to bit 7 (SJZ) of parameter No.0002
using rapid traverse without deceleration dogs after a
reference position is set.
<For T series>
FSA Valid data range for an F command in feed-per-minute mode
0: Range specified with bit 0 (MIF) of parameter No.1403
I: Increment system Units IS-A,IS-B 15-<:
Millimeter input mm/min 0.001 to 240000. 0.001 to 100000.
Inch input inch/min 0.00001 to 9600. 0.00001 to 4000.
Rotation axis deg/min 1to240000. 1 to 100000.
<For M series>
FSA Valid data range for an F command with a decimal point in feed-per
minute mode
0: Increment system Units IS-A,IS-B I 15-<:
Millimeter input mm/min 0.001 to 99999.999.
Inch input inch/min 0.00001 to 999.99999.
Rotation axis (mm) deg/min 1to240000. I 1 to 100000.
Rotation axis (inch) deg/min 1 to 9600. I 1 to 4000.
- 63 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 1410 I ~l~~~~~~~~~o-~_ru_n_ra_re~~~~~~~~~~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6 to 4800
Set the dry run rate when the manual feedrate is overridden by 100%.
- 64 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 1420 I ~l~~~~~~~R_•P_id_tr_av_•_~_•_ra_ra_ro_r_e_ac_h_ax_i•~~~~~~~
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 30 to 240000 6to 100000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 30 to 96000 6to 48000
Rotation axis 1 deg/min 30 to 240000 6to 100000
Set the rapid traverse rate when the rapid traverse override is 100% for
each axis.
I 1421 I ~l~~~~~F_o_ra_ra_o_fr_a_pid_t_ra_••-~~o_ve_r_rid_e_fo_r_eac~h-ax_is~~~~~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Valid data range
Increment system Unit of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 30 to 15000 30 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 30 to 6000 30 to 4800
Rolaion axis 1 deg/min 30 to 15000 30 to 12000
Set the FO rate of the rapid traverse override for each axis.
Rapid traverse override signal
Override value
ROV2 ROV1
0 0 100%
0 1 50%
1 0 25%
1 1 FO
FO: Parameter 1421
1422 I ~l~~~~~~M_ax~im_u_m_c_utt_in_g_fe_ed_r_m_ef_o_ra_ll_ax_•_•~~~~~~
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Valid data range
Increment system Unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 240000 610100000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 96000 610 48000
Specify the maximum cutting feedrate.
A feedrate in the tangential direction is clamped in cutting feed so that it
does not exceed the feedrate specified in this parameter.
- 65 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 A maximum cutting feedrate can be specified for each axis
only during linear interpolation and circular interpolation by
using parameter No. 1430.
2 Even when parameter No. 1430 is used, clamping to a
maximum cutting feedrate based on parameter No. 1422 is
enabled during polar coordinate interpolation, cylindrical
interpolation, and involute interpolation (M series).
1423 I ~I____Fa_ad_r_at_a_in_m_a_nu_a_Ico_n_t_inu_o_us_ra_a_d_O_og_f_aad_)f_or_aac_h_ax_i_•_ _~
[Data type] Word axis
(1) In M series, or in T series when JRV, bit 4 of parameter No.1402, is set
to 0 (feed per minute), specify a jog feedrate at feed per minute with an
override of 100%.
[Unit of data, valid range]
Velid data range
Increment system Unit of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6 to 4800
Rotaiton axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
(2) When JRV, bit 4 of parameter No.1402, is setto 1 (feed per revolution)
in T series, specify a jog feedarate (feed per revolution) under an
override of 100%.
[Unit of data, valid range]
Increment system unn DI data Valid data range
Millimeter machine 0.01 mm/rev
Inch machine 0.001 mm/rev o to 32767
Rotation axis O.Q1 deg/rev
1424 I ~I______M_a_nu_a_Ira_p_id_tr_av_e_rse_ra_te_fo_r_e_ac_h_ax_i•_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Valid data range
Increment system unn DI data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 30to 240000 30 to 100000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 30 to 96000 30 to 48000
Rotation axis 1 deg/min 30 to 240000 30 to 100000
Set the rate of manual rapid traverse when the rapid traverse override is
100% for each axis.
NOTE
If 0 is set, the rate set in parameter 1420 is assumed.
- 66 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1425 I ~I_____F_L_ra_te_o_f_th_e_ref_e_r_en_oe_pos_it_io_n_ret_u_rn_fo_r_e_ac_h_ax_is_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Yalld data range
Increment system Unit of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6 to 4800
Rotaion axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Set feedrate (FL rate) after deceleration when the reference position return
is performed for each axis.
I 1427 I ~l____~_e_rn_al_d_ece_le_ra_ti_on_ra_t_e_o_fr_ap_id_t_ra_v_e~_•_f_o_reac_h_ax_is_ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6 to 4800
Rotaion axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Set the external deceleration rate of rapid traverse for each axis.
1430 I ~l_______M_ax_im_um_cu_tt_in_g_ra_ed_r_e1_e_fo_r_ea_c_h_ax_i•_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word axis
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 240000 6 to 100000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 96000 6 to 48000
Rotaion axis 1 deg/min 6 to 240000 6 to 100000
- 67 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid only during linear interpolation and
circular interpolation. Even when this parameter is set,
clamping to a maximum cutting feedrate based on
parameter No. 1422 is enabled during polar coordinate
interpolation, cylindrical interpolation, and involute
interpolation (M series).
2 When this parameter is set to O for all axes, clamping to a
maximum cutting feedrate based on parameter No. 1422 is
enabled.
This means that if a value other than 0 is set for any of the axes
with this parameter, clamping to a maximum cutting feedrate
is performed for all axes during linear interpolation or circular
interpolation according to this parameter.
~ >--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-!
L:_j Maximum cutting feedrate for all axes in the look-ahead control mode
NOTE
1 To specify the maximum cutting feedrate for each axis, use
parameter No.1432 instead.
2 In a mode other than the look-ahead mode, the maximum
cutting feedrate specified in parameter No.1422 or No.1430
is applied and the feedrate is clamped at the maximum
feed rate.
EJ Maximum cutting feedrate for each axis in the Al look-ahead control mode or look-
- 68 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Specify the maximum cutting feedrate for each axis in the AI look-ahead
control mode or look-ahead control mode.
A feedrate for each axis is clamped during cutting feed so that it does not
exceed the maximum cutting feedrate specified for each axis.
NOTE
1 This parameter is effective only in linear and circular
interpolation. In cylindrical interpolation, the maximum
feedrate for all axes specified in parameter No.1431 is
effective.
2 If a setting for each axis is 0, the maximum feedrate specified
in parameter No.1431 is applied to all axes and the feedrate
is clamped at the maximum feedrate.
3 In a mode other than the Al look-ahead control mode or
look-ahead mode, the maximum cutting feedrate specified
in parameter No.1422 or No.1430 is applied and the
feedrate is clamped at the maximum feedrate.
EJ ~C-h-•n_g_•_of_f•_ed_•_•t_•
450
In the above equation, set n. That is, the number of revolutions of the
manual pulse generator, required to reach feedrate Fmaxi is obtained.
Fmaxi refers to the upper limit of the feedrate for an Fl-digit feed
command, and set it in parameter 1460 or 1461.
Fmaxl: Upper limit of the feedrate for Fl to F4 (parameter 1460)
Fmax2: Upper limit of the feedrate for F5 to F9 (parameter 1461)
- 69 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
B
r-;:;;l
Feed rate for F1 digit command F8
These parameters set the feedrates for 1--<ligit feed commands Fl to F9.
When an 1--<ligit feed command is specified, and the feedrate is changed
by turning the manual pulse generator, the parameter-set value also
changes accordingly.
- 70 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ t--~-..,.,~-,--,.--,.,..-.,..--,--,-~---,,....,-=-..,..-~~-..,,=---=,,.-~---l
L:J Upper limit of feed rate for the one-digit F code command (F1 to F4)
~
~
t--~-..,.,~-,-----,~---,-,--,-~~-,-=-..,..-~~-..,,=---=~~---1
Upper limit of feed rate for the one-digit F code command (FS to F9)
~ >---~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~---!
L:J Virtual radius for feed rate control about rotation axis
NOTE
1 Note that the increment system remains unchanged
regardless of whether metric input or inch input is used.
2 This function is enabled when bit 0 (ROTx) of parameter No.
1006 and bit 0 (RFDx) of parameter No. 1408 are set to 1.
3 Be careful when setting bit 0 (RFDx) of parameter No. 1408
and parameter No. 1465 (virtual radius). In particular, when
this function is used with a small virtual radius value, axis
movement speeds up.
4 If a large value is set for the amount of travel and parameter
No. 1465 (virtual radius), an alarm (P/S 5307: Internal data
exceeded an allowable range.) is issued.
5 This function cannot be used in the following modes:
Rapid traverse, feed per revolution (G94), threading, Al
look-ahead control, high-speed remote buffer A,
high-speed remote buffer B
- 71 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS B--63610EN/01
4.16
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
ACCELERATION/
DECELERATION ~ ~1---+-----+-:-~-:--+--:-~---+---+--0-V-B--+----+------<
CONTROL [Data type] Bit
OVB Block overlap in cutting feed
0: Blocks are not overlapped in cutting feed.
1: Blocks are overlapped in cutting feed.
Block overlap outputs the pulses remaining at the end of pulse
distribution in a block together with distribution pulses in the next block.
This eliminates changes in feedrates between blocks.
Block overlap is enabled when blocks containing GOl, G02, or G03 are
consecutively specified in G64 mode. If minute blocks, however, are
specified consecutively, overlap may not be performed.
The following pulses in block F2 are added to the pulses remaining at the
end of pulse distribution in block Fl.
(Number of pulses required at the end of block Fl)
(Number of pulses to be added) =Fl x - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Fl
When Fl =Fl
F F1 F2
F F1 F2
NOTE
See the description of parameter No.1722.
- 72 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l+----+---Ls-2-+--~-:-:-+--c-s-o-+---BS2--+--c-o-v-+----+--FW-B__,
[Data type] Bit
FWB Cutting feed acceleration/deceleration before interpolation
0 : Type A of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is used.
1 : Type B of acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is used.
Type A: When a feedrate is to be changed by a command,
acceleration/deceleration starts after the program enters the
block in which the command is specified.
Type B: When a feedrate is to be changed by a command, deceleration
starts and terminates at the block before the blcock in which the
command is specified.
When a feedrate is to be changed by a command, acceleration
starts after the program enters theblock in which the command
is specified.
COV The outer arc cutting feedrate change function of the automatic corner
override function is:
0: Not used.
1: Used.
BS2 Acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for cutting feed in
look-ahead control mode is:
0 : Exponential acceleration/deceleration or linear acceleration/
deceleration (one of which is selected by the LS2 parameter (bit 6 of
parameter No.1602)).
1 : Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration.
BS2 LS2 Acceleration/deceleration
0 0 Exponential acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
0 1 Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation. (The
option for linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
for cutting feed is required.)
1 0 Bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation.
(The option for bell-shaf.ed acceleration/deceleration after
interpolation for cutting eed is required.)
- 73 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS B--63610EN/01
NOTE
1 FAD (fine acceleration/deceleration) cannot be applied to
the spindles. When serial spindle look-ahead control is
applied, therefore, FAD cannot be used for the servo axes.
2 For Cs contour control, look-ahead control is valid only for
the first spindle. Cs contour control with the second spindle
does not support look-ahead control.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ ~1~~+--A-BL--+~~--+--:-:-~-+~~-+-~~+--~-+~~~
[Data type] Bit
RPT The acceleration/deceleration of interpolation-type rapid traverse is
performed:
0: With a constant inclination.
1: With a constant time.
NOTE
This parameter is invalid if the function of bell-shaped
acceleration/deceleration after rapid-traverse
interpolation is provided. The acceleration/deceleration
time constant and override for rapid traverse are used.
NOTE
Bit 4 (RPT) of parameter No. 1603 is invalid.
- 74 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1610 I l~-~--~--~-J_G_Lx~--~--~-c_T_Bx~_c_TLx~
[Data type] Bit axis
CTLx Acceleration/deceleration in cutting feed including feed in dry run
0 : Exponential acceleration/deceleration is applied.
1 : Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is applied.
NOTE
If the optional function of linear acceleration/deceleration
after interpolation in cutting feed is not provided, exponential
acceleration/deceleration is used irrespective of this setting.
To use bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after
interpolation, set this parameter to 0 and select the
acceleration/deceleration using CTBx, bit 1 of parameter
No.1610.
Parameter
Acceleration/deceleration
CTBx CTLx
0 0 Exponential acceleration/deceleration
0 1 Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
1 0 BelH>haped acceleration/deceleration after in1erpolalion
NOTE
This parameter is effective only when the function of
bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in
cutting feed is provided. If the function is not provided, the
setting in CTLx, bit 0 of parameter No.161 0, determines the
type of acceleration/deceleration irrespective of the setting
in this parameter.
- 75 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When parameter No.1621 (time constant T2 used for
bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse) is
set to 0, linear acceleration/deceleration is applied in rapid
traverse even if the function is provided. In this case, this
parameter stands for a time constant used in linear
acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse.
Time
- 76 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the value when the rapid traverse rate is 100%. If it is under 100%, the
total time is reduced. (Constant acceleration method)
The value of T 1 is determined from the torque of motor. Usually set the
value ofTz to 24 ms ir 32 ms.
~
~ ~"-'m_•_co_n_st_•_m_t_T
_ verse for each axis
2_u_•ed-fo_•_b•_ll_"_h_ap_ed_acce_l•_••_t_ion}_d_ece_l•_ra_t_io-ni_n_••-pid-tra_-~
[Unit of data] ms
NOTE
1 This parameter is effective when the function of bell-shaped
acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse is provided. Set
parameter No.1620 to time constant T1 used for
bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse, and
set this parameter to time constant T2 .
For details of time constants T1 and T2 , see the description
of parameter No.1620.
2 When this parameter is set to 0, linear acceleration/
deceleration is applied in rapid traverse. The setting in
parameter No.1620 is used as a time constant in linear
acceleration/deceleration.
B 1622
[Unit of data] ms
- 77 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Speed
T : Total time. it is constant irrespective of feed rate.
(Time constant is constant).
Time
T
NOTE
Except for special applications, this parameter must be set
to 0 for all axes. If a value other than 0 is specified, proper
straight lines and arcs cannot be obtained.
- 78 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1625 I I. .__F_L_ra_1_e_of_e_xpo_n_en_ti_a1_a_cce_1e_ra_tio_n1_d_ece_1e_r_a1_io_n_in_io_g_fe_ed_fo_r_ea_c_h_ax_is_._ _,
EJ
Time constant of axponetial acceleration/deceleration in the thread cutting cycle
for each axis
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
FL rate of exponential acceleration /deceleration in the thread cutting cycle for
each axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mnnlmin 6 to 15000 6to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6to 4800
Rotaion axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6to 12000
- 79 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) of the inner circular cutting rate in automatic
corner override
/ ---- --,
' '\
\
\ Programmed path
Path oflhe I
cutter's center I
If Re is too small in comparison with Rp, such that Rc/Rp 0, the cutter =
will stop. To prevent this, a minimum deceleration ratio (MOR) is set.
~ r1~~~~~~-A-m-o-un_t_m_o_ve-m-.d-e_ro_r_a_n-in-ne_r_co_r-ne-r~~~~~~--1
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 1 to 100 (standard value= 50)
Set the amount of override for an inner comer.
- 80 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
a
[Data type] Word
Distance Ls up to the ending point in inner corner override
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter input 1 0.1 0.01 mm
Inch input 0.1 0.01 0.001 inch
Programmed
path
Cutter center
path
An override is applied from point a to b.
- 81 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
1722 II Rapid traverse feed rate reduction ratio for overlapping rapid traverse blocks
N1 GOOX--; N2GOOX--;
NOTE
The parameter No.1722 is effective when parameter
No.1601 #4 (RTO) is set to 1.
~ r1~~~~~~~M-ax_i_m_u_m_re_ed_ra_t_e_fo_r_ar_c_ra_d-iu_s_R~~~~~~---1
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
Yalld data range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min B to 15000 Oto 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min B to 6000 oto 4800
Set a maximum feedrate for the arc radius set in parameter No.1731. Set
this parameter when the arc radius-based feedrate clamping function is
enabled.
- 82 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
B
[Data type] 2-word
Arc radius value corresponding to a maximum feed rate
[Unit of data]
Unit IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Linear axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
(millimeter machine)
Linear axis 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
(inch machine)
[Valid data range] 1000 to 99999999
Set the arc radius corresponding to the maximum feedrate set in parameter
No.1730. Set this parameter when the arc radius-based feedrate clamping
function is enabled.
B
[Data type] Word
Minimum value (RV min) for arc radius-based feedrate clamp
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
Exponential acceleration/deceleration time constant for cutting feed in the look-
ahead control mode
[Unit of data] 1 ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 4000
Set an exponential acceleration/deceleration time constant for cutting
feed in the look-ahead control mode.
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
Minimum speed in exponential acceleration/deceleration for cutting feed in the
look-ahead control mode
- 83 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
[Data type] Word
Time constant for linear acceleration/deceleration or bell-shaped acceleration/
deceleration during cutting feed in lock-ahead control mode.
[Unit of data] ms
NOTE
1 For linear acceleration/deceleration, the function of linear
acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation is
required.
2 For bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration, the function of
bell-shaped acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed
interpolation is required.
EJ
[Data type] 2-word
Parameter 1 {for look-ahead control) for setting an acceleration for linear ac-
celeration/deceleration before interpolation (maximum machining speed during
linearacceleration/decelerationbeforeinte ...... lation\
Speed
Parameter1 ----
(No.1770)
Time
Parameter 2 (No.1771)
- 84 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When O is set in parameter No.1770 or parameter No.1771,
linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is
disabled.
EJ
[Data type] Word
Parameter2 {for look-ahead control) for setting an acceleration for linear ac-
celeration/deceleration before interpolation {time used to reach the maximum
machinina sn.a.ed durino linear acceleration/deceleration before internnlation1
NOTE
1 When O is set in parameter No.1770 or parameter No.1771,
linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is
disabled.
2 In parameter Nos. 1770 and 1771 , set values that satisfy the
following:
Parameter No.1770/Parameter No.1771 ~ 5
~
~ Minimum speed for the automatic corner deceleration function (look-ahead control)
EJ
[Data type] 2-word
Critical angle subtended by two blocks for automatic comer deceleration (for
lool<-ahead control)
- 85 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Block A (G01)
Block B (G01)
0 0
Block A (G02)
Block B (G01)
Angle subtended by two straight lines Angle subtended by an arc and its tangent
EJ
[Data type] Word
Allowable speed difference for the speed difference-based cornerdeceleration
function (for look-ahead control)
Set the speed difference for the speed difference-based automatic corner
deceleration function when linear acceleration/deceleration before
interpolation is used.
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
Allowable speed difference for the speed difference based corner deceleration
function (for look-ahead control)
A separate allowable feedrate difference can be set for each axis. The
allowable feedrate difference is set for each axis with this parameter.
Among the axes that exeed the specified allowable feedrate difference, the
axis with the greatest ratio of the actual feedrate difference to the
allowable feedrate difference is used as the reference to calculate the
reduced feedrate at the corner.
- 86 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ ~S-p_ea_d_w_h•_n_o_v•_rt_ra_••_l_a1a_•_m_h•_•_g_•n_•_••_!ad-du_n_·ng_acc_•_l•_••_ti_on1_d_•_ca_l•_••-ti-on-~
L:_J _ before interpolation (for look-ahead control)
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Valid range
Increment system unn of data
IS-A, IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6to 4800
Rotation axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6to 12000
NOTE
1 When 0 is set in this parameter, the control described above
is not exercised.
2 Use type-B linear acceleration/deceleration before
interpolation (by setting bit O (FWB) of parameter No.1602
to 1).
3 The control described above is applicable only to stored
stroke check 1.
- 87 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.17
#7 #8 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAMETERS OF
SERVO
1800 I l~-~--~-TR_c_~R_B_K~_F_F_R~_oz_R_~c_v_R~--~
[Data type] Bit
CVR When velocity control ready signal VRDY is set ON before position
control ready signal PRDY comes ON
0: A servo alarm is generated.
1: A servo alarm is not generated.
OZR When manual reference position return is attempted in the bait state
during automatic operation (feed bold stop state) under any of the
conditions listed below:
0: Manual reference position return is not performed, with P/S alarm
No.091.
1: Manual reference position return is performed without an alarm
occurring.
< Conditions >
(1) When there is a remaining distance to travel.
(2) When an auxiliary function (miscellaneous function, spindle-speed
function, tool function) is being executed.
(3) When a cycle such as a dwell cycle or canned cycle is being executed.
FFR Feed-forward control is enabled for
0 : Cutting feed only
1 : Cutting feed and rapid traverse
RBK Backlash compensation applied separately for cutting feed and rapid
traverse
0: Not performed
1: Performed
TRC The servo trace functon is:
0: Disabled
1 : Enabled (Also set parameter No.1870.)
The digital servo software for learning control is necessary.
#7 #8 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Bl
[Data type] Bit
CIN
CIN
CCI
CCI
API
API
PM2 PM1
PM1,PM2 Sets a gear ratio between the spindle and motor when the servo
motor-based speed control function is used.
Magnification PM2 PM1
1/1 0 0
1/2 0 1 spindle speed
Magnification= - - - - -
1/4 1 0 motor speed
1/8 1 1
API To use an absolute position detector for any axis, set API to 1.
- 88 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
After this parameter is set, the power needs to be turned off.
#7 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 1803 I l.__~-'-~~-'-~~'--T-Q_F_,_~~-'-~~'--T-Q_A__._~T-Q_I~
[Data type] Bit
TQI While torque restriction is applied, in-position check is:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed.
TQA While torque restriction is applied, checking for an excessive error in tbe
stopped state/during movement is:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed.
- 89 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When a reset is issued while the VRDY OFF alarm ignore
signal is set to 1 and the motor activating current is low, the
reset state can also be released, provided this parameter is
setto1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 1aos I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~T_a_u~-~
[Data type] Bit
TQU If follow-up is not performed by the torque control command of PMC
axis control, the servo error counter is:
0: Updated.
1: Not updated.
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if follow-up is not performed (bit 4
(TQF) of parameter No. 1803 is set to 0).
2 When torque control is switched to position control, a
reference position return must be made.
- 90 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1815 I l~-~--~-AP_ex_~A_P_zx~--~-oc_Lx_~o_PT_•~--~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
When using the linear scale with reference marks, also set
the OPTx parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.1815) to 1.
APZx Machine position and position on absolute position detector when the
absolute position detector is used
0 : Not corresponding
1 : Corresponding
NOTE
When an absolute position detector is used, after primary
adjustment is performed or after the absolute position
detector is replaced, this parameter must be set to 0, power
must be turned off and on, then manual reference position
return must be performed. This completes the positional
correspondence between the machine position and the
position on the absolute position detector, and sets this
parameter to 1 automatically.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 1817 I l.___ _.__ __.___._s_c_Px_.__ _.___ _.__ __._ ___,
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 91 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
0: On the negative direction side. (Viewed from the scale zero point, the
reference position is on the positive direction side.)
1: On the positive direction side. (Viewed from the scale zero point, the
reference position is on the negative direction side.)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1818 I l'-----'---'----'----'----'--D-G_o_x_.__R_F_2x---'-R-FS_x_,
[Data type] Bit axis type
RFSx On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks,
if an automatic reference position return (G28) is made before the
reference position is established, the reference position is established first,
then:
0: A movement to the reference position is made.
1: A movement to the reference position is not made, but the operation is
completed.
RF2x On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks,
if an automatic reference position return (G28) is made after the reference
position is established,
0: A movement to the reference position is made.
1: A movement to the reference position is not made, but the operation is
completed.
DGOx On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks, a
reference position return by jog feed or a rapid traverse command is:
0: Disabled.
1: Enabled.
~ #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ ~
B 1819
I
.
FUPx To perform follow-up when the servo is off is set for each axis.
0: The follow-up signal, *FLWU, determines whether follow-up is
performed or not
When *FLWU is 0, follow-up is performed.
When *FLWU is l, follow-up is not performed.
1: Follow-up is not performed.
NOTE
When the index table indexing function (M series) is used,
be sure to set FUPx of the 4th axis to 1.
- 92
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
This parameter is automatically set to 0 when the manual
reference position return is completed.
NOTE
Set1 for a PMC-based control axis.
1820 I ~I_______c_o_m_m_a_n_d_m_u_lti_Pl_ie_r_fo_re_a_c_h_ax_i_s_(C_M_R_l_ _ _ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
Least
Least Input Increment command
increment
15-C Millimeter Millimeter 0.0001 mm (diameter specification) 0.00005mm
machine input
0.0001 mm (radius specification) 0.0001 mm
Inch input 0.00001 inch {diameter specification) 0.00005mm
0.00001 inch (radius specification) 0.0001 mm
Inch Millimeter 0.0001 mm {diameter specification) o.ooooos inch
machine input
0.0001 mm (radius specification) 0.00001 inch
Inch input 0.00001 inch {diameter specification) 0.000005 inch
0.00001 inch {radius specification) 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.0001 d"" 0.0001 deo
- 93 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
(2) M series
Increment Least Input Increment and least command Increment
system IS-A IS-B I~ Units
Millimetermachine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
+ DA
XCMR Error counter ~
Converter _.. To velocity control
least command -
increment
"
Feedback pulse
Reference
counter XDMR Position detector
Detection
unit
Fig.4.17 (a) CMR, DMR, and the Capacity of the Reference Counter
Set the magnification ratios of CMR and DMR so that the weight of
positive inputs to the error counter equals that of negative inputs.
NOTE
When command multiplier is 1 to 48, the set value must be
determined so that an integer can be set for command
multiplier.
- 94 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
I 1825 I ~l________se_~_o_lo_o_p_ga_in_ro_r_e_ac_h_ax_i_s_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] 0.01 s -1
[Valid data range] 1 to 9999
Set the loop gain for position control for each axis.
When the machine performs linear and circular interpolation (cutting), the
same value must be set for all axes. When the machine requires
positioning only, the values set for the axes may differ from one another.
As the loop gain increases, the response by position control is improved.
A too large loop gain, however, makes the servo system unstable.
The relationship between the positioning deviation (the number of pulses
counted by the error counter) and the feedrate is expressed as follows:
Positioning deviation = ___fee~d_ra~te~--
60 X (loop gain)
Unit : Positioning deviation mm, inches, or deg
Feedrate : mm/min, inches/min, or deg/min
loop gain: s-1
1826 I ~I_______1_n-po_s_iu_·o_nw_i_dt_h_fo_re_a_ch_ax_i•_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
The in-position width is set for each axis.
When the deviation of the machine position from the specified position
(the absolute value of the positioning deviation) is smaller than the
in-position width, the machine is assumed to have reached the specified
position. (The machine is in the in-position state.)
I 1827 I ~l______1n-pos
_ _it_io_n~_·_~_h_in_c_uw_·n_g_ra_ed_ro_re_a_ch_ax_i_•_ _ _ _~
- 95 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
I 1829 I ~I____P_o_si_tio_n_in_g_de_v_ia_tio_n_li_m_it_fo_r_ea_c_h_ax_is_i_n_th_e_st_op_pe_d_st_at_e_ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
Set the positioning deviation limit in the stopped state for each axis.
If, in the stopped state, the positioning deviation exceeds the positioning
deviation limit set for stopped state, a servo alarm is generated, and
operation is stopped immediately (as in emergency stop).
NOTE
When this parameter is set to 0, no positional deviation limit
check is made at servo-off time.
1836 I ~I___s_e_rvo_e_rro_r_a_m_ou_n_tw_h_e_re_ref_e_re_nc_e_po_s_iti_·o_n_ret_u_r_ni_s_pos_si_bl_•_ _~
[Data type] Byte axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 127
This parameter sets a servo error used to enable reference position return
in manual reference position return.
In general, set this parameter to 0. (When 0 is set, 128 is assumed as the
default.)
-%-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When bit 0 (PLC01) of parameter No.2000 is set to 1, a value
ten times greater than the value set in this parameter is used
to make the check.
Example
When the value 1Ois set in this parameter, and bit O(PLC01)
of parameter No.2000 is set to 1, reference
1850 I ~l________G_r_id_sh_ift_s_h_m_ro_r_ea_c_hax_is_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
I 1851 I ~l______B_ackl_as_h_co_m_p_e_nsa_tin_g_v_alu_e_ro_r_ea_c_h_ax_is_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] -9999 to +9999
Set the backlash compensating value for each axis.
When the machine moves in a direction opposite to the reference position
return direction after the power is turned on, the first backlash
compensation is performed.
1852 I ~--Bac_kl_as_h_co_m_pe_ns_at_in_g_va_1u_e_u_se_d_fo_r_r•_Pi_d_tra_v_ers_e_r_or_•_•c_h_ax_i_s-~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] -9999 to +9999
Set the backlash compensating value used in rapid traverse for each axis.
This parameter is valid when RBK, #4 of parameter 1800, is set to 1.
More precise machining can be performed by changing the backlash
compensating value depending on the feedrate, the rapid traverse or the
cutting feed.
Let the measured backlash at cutting feed be A and the measured backlash
at rapid traverse be B. The backlash compensating value is shown below
depending on the change of feedrate (cutting feed or rapid traverse) and
the change of the direction of movement.
- 97 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
\ Change of feedrate Cutting feed to Rapid traverse Rapid traverse to Cutting feed to
Change of direction of movement \ cutting feed to rapid traverse cutting feed rapid traverse
Assign the measured backlash at cutting feed (A) in parameter No.1851 and that at rapid traverse (B) in param-
eter No.1852.
NOTE
1 Jog feed is regarded as cutting feed.
2 The backlash compensation depending on a rapid traverse and a cutting feed is not performed
until the first reference position return is completed after the power is turned on. The normal
backlash compensation is performed according to the value specified in parameter No.1851
irrespective of a rapid traverse and a cutting feed.
3 The backlash compensation depending on a rapid traverse and a cutting feed is performed only
when RBK, #4 of parameter No.1800, is set to 1. When RBK is set to 0, the normal backlash
is performed.
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 98 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 1876 I ~l______o_n_e-jl_im_h_inre_~_•_l_ct_th_e_ind_u_cto_s_y_n_ _ _ _ _~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
SUPPLEMENTAL REMARK
To use an absolute-position detector using lnductosyn, set
the following digital servo parameters as well:
1880 I ~I______A_b_no_rm_a_11o_a_d_de_1e_ct_io_na1_a_rm_tim_e_r_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767 (200 mse is assumed when 0 is set)
This parameter sets the time from the detection of an abnormal load until a
servo alarm is issued. The specified value is rounded up to the nearest
integral multiple of 8 msec.
[Example] When 30 is specified, the value is rounded up to 32 (msec).
I 1881 I ~----Gr_ou_p_n_um_b_e_rwh_en_a_n_ab_n_or_m_a1_1o_ad_is_d_e_re_cted_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte axis
[Valid data range] 0 to 4
This parameter sets the group number of each axis, used when an
abnormal load is detected.
If an abnormal load is detected for an axis, only the movement along the
axes of the group containing the axis with the abnormal load is stopped. If
- 99 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the ANA parameter (bit 5 of
parameter No.1804) is 1.
1882 Space between the mark-2 indications on the linear scale with reference marks
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then back on for the setting to become effective.
~ ~D-is_ta_n_ce_rr_o_m_th_•_••_•_o
L.::_J _ erence position p-o-in_to-f-th_•_lin_ea_r_sc_•_l•_w_it_h_ref_•_••_nce_m_•_rks-to-th_•_••_f-~
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then back on for the setting to become effective.
- 100-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
41.8
IE ParameterNo.1821
ParameterNo.1882
ParameterNo.1883
~ ~O-is_ta_n_ce_2_1ro_m_th_•_'"_'o_po_int_o1_1h_•_lin_•_•'_•_ca_l•_wi_·1-habs_o_1u1_•_•_d_dr_•_ss_in_g_r•_fe_r-~
L.::_J _ ence marks to the reference position
NOTE
After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
back on for the setting to become effective.
I 1885 I ~l___M_ax_i_m_um_a1_1owa_b_la_v_a1_ua_m_r_to1_a_11_ra_va_l_du_ri_ng_t_o~_u_a_co_nt_ro_1_ _~
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
This parameter sets the maximum allowable value for the total travel
(error counter value) for an axis placed under torque control, as specified
by the axis control command of the PMC axis control function. If the total
travel exceeds the parameter-.'let value while torque control is applied, a
servo alarm (No.423) is generated.
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the TQF parameter (bit 4 of
parameter No.1803) is 0 (follow-up is not performed during
torque control).
- 101 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the TQF parameter (bit 4 of
parameter No.1803) is 0 (follow-up is not performed during
torque control).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1002 11 ASE FMD
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then back on for the setting to become effective.
- 102-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1904 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-DS_P___.
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then back on for the setting to become effective.
NOTE
Parameter No.1904 is set on the FSSB setting screen. So,
parameter No.1904 should not have to be specified directly.
This parameter need not be set in FSSB manual setting 2
mode.
1905 I l.__P_M_2___,~P_M_1_,_~10_2~'---10_1___,~~-'-~~-'-~~-'--F-S_L_,
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then back on for the setting to become effective.
- 103 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
CNC
1 x 1 F
I - X (Fast)
y 2-axis
2 2 F amplifier -
3 z 3 s A(Slow)
4 A 4 s 1-axis
- Y (Fast)
amplifier
1-axis Z(Slow)
amplifier
NOTE
When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
(when the FMD parameter (bit Oof parameter No.1902) is set
to 0), parameter No.1905 is automatically set when input is
performed with the FSSB setting screen. When manual
setting 2 mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the FMD
parameter (bit O of parameter No.1902) is set to 1),
parameter No.1905 must be set directly. When a separate
detecter interface unit is used, a connector number must be
set in the corresponding parameter (No.1936 or No.1937).
- 104-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
After these parameters have been set, the power must be
turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
NOTE
When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
(when the FMD parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1902) is
set to 0), parameters No.191 O through No.1919 are
automatically set when input is performed with the FSSB
setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode is selected for
FSSB setting (when the FMD parameter (bit 0 of parameter
No.1902) is set to 1), parameter No.1910 through No.1919
must be directly set.
- 105 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS B--63610EN/01
G
Controlled Program Servo axis Slave ATR
axis axis name number number No.1910
number No.1020 No.1023 to 1919
1 xy 1
2 3 0 x
3 z 4
4 A 2 2 A
3 2 y
M1 4 16 (M1)
1-axis
am lifier 5 3 z
M2 6 48 (M2)
7 40 (None)
8 40 (None)
9 40 {None)
10 40 {None)
CNC
G
Controlled Program Servo axis Slave ATR
axis axis name number number No.1910
number No.1020 No.1023 to 1919
1 xy 1
1--axis
2 3 0 x
3 z 4 am lifier
4 A 2 y
2--axis 2
amplifier 3 2 A
1--axis
amplifier 4 4 z
M1 5 16 {M1)
M2 6 48 {M2)
7 40 (None)
8 40 (None)
9 40 (None)
10 40 (None)
Note) M1 /M2: First separate detecter interface unit/second separate detecter interface unit
- 106-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1920 Controlled axis number for slave 1 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1921 Controlled axis number for slave 2 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1922 Controlled axis number for slave 3 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1923 Controlled axis number for slave 4 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1924 Controlled axis number for slave 5 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1925 Controlled axis number for slave 6 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1926 Controlled axis number for slave 7 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1927 Controlled axis number for slave 8 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1928 Controlled axis number for slave 9 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1929 Controlled axis number for slave 10 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
NOTE
After these parameters have been set, the power must be
turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
Connector number for the first separate detecter interface unit (dedicated to the
FSSB setting screen)
Conneclllr nuni:Jer far 1he second separate detecisr inlerface urit (dedicated ID 1he
FSSB -~ screen)
NOTE
After these parameters have been set, the power must be
turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
NOTE
These parameters are set using the FSSB setting screen.
So, these parameters should not normally have to be
specified directly. These parameters need not be set in
FSSB manual setting 2 mode.
- 107 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
This parameter is set using the FSSB setting screen. So,
this parameter should not normally have to be specified
directly. This parameter need not be set in FSSB manual
setting 2 mode.
1936 I I. . ___c_o_nn_e_ct_or_n_um_b_e_rof_th_e_firs_t_s_ep_a_ra_te_d_etecte
__r_in_te_ria_ce_un_it_ _~
1937 I ~I___eo_nn_e_cto_r_n_u_m_be_r_of_th_•_••_co_n_d_se_p_a_ra_te_d_et_ect_e_r_in_t•_riac_e_un_it_ _~
NOTE
After these parameters have been set, the power must be
turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
- 108 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
(when bit 0 of parameter No.1902 is set to 0), these
parameters are automatically set when input is performed
with the FSSB setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode
is selected for FSSB setting (when bit O of parameter
No.1902 is set to 1), these parameters must be set directly.
- 109-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Parameters No.2000 to 2999 are for digital servo, The following parameters are not explained in this manual.
Refer to FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR a series PARAMETER MANUAL (B-65150E)
No. Data type Contents
2000 Bit axis PGEX PRMC DGPR PLCO
2001 Bit axis AMR7 AMR6 AMR5 AMR4 AMR3 AMR2 AMR1 AMRO
2002 Bit axis VFSE PFSE
2003 Bit axis VOFS ovsc BLEN NPSP PIEN OBEN TGAL
2004 Bit axis DLYO TRW1 TRWO TIBO TIAO
2005 Bit axis SFCM BRKC FEED
2006 Bit axis DCBE ACCF SPVE PKVE SBSM FCBL
2007 Bit axis FRCA FAD
2008 Bit axis LAXD PFBS VCTM SPPC SPPR VFBA TNDM
2009 Bit axis BLST BLCU ADBL IQOB SERO
2010 Bit axis POLE HBBL HBPE BLTE LINE
2011 Bit axis RCCL FFALWY SYN MOD
2012 Bit axis STNG VCM2 VCM1 MSFE
2013 Bit axis APTG
2014 Bit axis (Reserve)
2015 Bit axis BZNG BLAT TDOU SSG1 PGTW
2016 Bit axis K2VC ABNT
2017 Bit axis PK25 OVCR RISC HTNG OBST
2018 Bit axis PFBC MOVO REVS
2019 Bit axis DPFB SPSY
2020 Word axis Motor number
2021 Word axis Load inertia ratio
2022 Word axis Direction of motor rotation
2023 Word axis Number of velocity pulses
2024 Word axis Number of position pulses
2028 Word axis Position gain switching speed
2029 Word axis Effective speed for integral acceleration at low speed
2030 Word axis Effective speed for integral deceleration at low speed
2033 Word axis Position feedback pulse
2034 Word axis Damping control gain
2039 Word axis Second-stage acceleration for two-stage backlash acceleration
2040 Word axis Current loop integral gain (PK1)
2041 Word axis Current loop proportional gain {PK2)
2042 Word axis Current loop gain (PK3)
2043 Word axis Velocity loop integral gain (PK1 V)
2044 Word axis Velocity loop proportional gain (PK2V)
2045 Word axis Velocity loop incomplete integral gain (PK3V)
2046 Word axis Velocity loop gain (PK4V)
2047 Word axis Observer parameter {POA1)
2048 Word axis Backlash acceleration
2049 Word axis Maximum amplibJde for dual position feedback
2050 Word axis Observer parameter (POK1)
2051 Word axis Observer parameter (POK2)
2053 Word axis Current dead zone compensation (PP MAX)
2054 Word axis Current dead zone compensation (PDDP)
2055 Word axis Current dead zone compensation (PHYST)
2056 Word axis Counterectromotiveforcecompensation {EMFCMP)
2057 Word axis Current phase lead compensation {PVPA)
2058 Word axis Current phase lead compensation (PALPH)
2059 Word axis Counterelectromotiveforcecompensation{EMFBAS)
2060 Word axis Torque limit
- 110 -
~3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
- 111 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 112 -
~3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.18
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAMETERS OF ~300_1~I I MHI RWM
DI/DO
[Data type] Bit
RWM RWD signal indicating that rewinding is in progress
0 : Output only when the tape reader is being rewound by the reset and
rewind signal RRW
1 : Output when the tape reader is being rewound or a program in
memory is being rewound by the reset and rewind signal RRW
MID Exchange of strobe and completion signals for the M, S, T, and B codes
0: Normal
1 : High-speed
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 3002 I l~-~-~--~-1o_v~--~-~-~-~
[Data type] Bit
IOV For the feedrate override signal, second feedrate override signal, and rapid
traverse override signal:
0 : Negative logic is used.
1 : Positive logic is used.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
81 I ~:I
[Data type] Bit
DEC
DEC
DAU DIT
DIT
ITX
ITX
ITL
ITL
- 113 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7
3004 I l~~~~~~-o_r_H~~~~~~~~~-B_c_v~~B-SL~
[Data type] Bit
BSL The block start interlock signal *BSL and cutting block start interlock
signal *CSL are:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
BCY When more than one operation is performed by one block command such
as a canned cycle, the block start interlock signal *BSL is:
0 : Checked only at the beginning of the first cycle.
1 : Checked at the beginning of every cycle.
NOTE
This is enabled when the BSL parameter (bit 0 of parameter
No.3004) is set to 1.
WARNING
For safety, usually set 0 to check the overtravel limit signal.
#7 #6 #2 #1 #0
- 114 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3010 I I. . _____TI_1m_e_1ag_in_s1_ro_b_•_•_ig_na_1._M_F_,s_F_,T_F_,•_n_d_B_F_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] 1 ms
[Valid data range] 16 to 32767
The time required to send strobe signals MF, SF, TF, and BF after the M, S,
T, and B codes are sent, respectively.
M, S, T, B code
NOTE
The time is counted in units of 8 ms. If the set value is not
a multiple of eight, it is raised to the next multiple of eight.
Example
When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
When 32 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
When 100 ie set, 104 ms is assumed.
3011 Acc_•P'_•_b_le_wi_·dt_h_of_M_,_s_,_T,_an_d_B_fu_n_ct_io_n_co_m_p_le1_io_n_s_ign_a_1(_F_IN_)-~
I .__I_ _ _
M, S, T, B code--~
FIN sigal
H
Ignored be- Valid because
cause shorter longer than min.
than min. signal width
signal width
Fig.4.18(b) Valid Width of the FIN (M,S, T, and B Function Completion)
Signal
- 115 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
The time is counted in units of 8 ms. If the set value is not
a multiple of eight, it is raised to the next multiple of eight.
Example
When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
3017 I ~I_______o_u1_p_u1_1i_m_e_or_res_e1_si_gn_a_1R_S_T_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] 16 ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
To extend the output time of reset signal RST, the time to be added is
specified in this parameter.
RST signal output time =time veguired for reset+ parameter x 16 ms
NOTE
Up to 5 digits can be specified in the S code
- 116 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.19
PARAMETERS OF #0
MDI, DISPLAY, I 3100 I l~c_o_R~--~-~--~F_KY_~s_KY_~c_E_M~-~
AND EDIT [Data type] Bit
CEM On screens such as the operation history screen and help screen, keys on
the MDI panel are indicated:
0 : In English.
1 : With graphics qualifying for CE marking. (A character generator
supporting graphics qualifying for CE marking is required.)
SKY MDI key board use:
0 : Standard keys.
1 : Small keys.
NOTE
Set this parameter when using the 9.5"/10.4" LCD (with ten
soft keys). After this parameter has been set, the power must
be turned off then back on for the setting to become
effective.
NOTE
Set this parameter when using the 7 .2"/8.4" LCD (with seven
soft keys). After this parameter has been set, the power must
be turned off then back on for the setting to become
effective.
COR Display
0 : Monochrome display
1 : Color display
NOTE
When using the 8.4" LCD, set this bit to 1.
#7 #5 #0
I 3101 I l~-~--~-~-B_G_D~--~-~-KB_F~-~
[Data type] Bit
KBF When the screen or mode is changed, the contents of the key-in buffer are:
0: Cleared.
1 : Not cleared.
- 117 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When KBF = 1, the contents of the key-in buffer can all be
[CA•] key.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
B DTH
#7
SPN
SPN
#6
HNG
HNG
#5
ITA
ITA
#4
CHI
CHI
#3
FRN
FRAN
#2
GRM
GRM
#1
JPN
JPN
#0
3119 11 POR
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3190 HUN
11
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 118 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When PPD is set to 1 and the absolute posnion display is
preset by one of the following, the relative position display is
also preset to the same value as the absolute posttion display:
1) The manual reference position return
2) Setting of a coordinate system by G92 (G50 for T series
G code system A)
NOTE
When tool geometry compensation of the T system is to be
performed by shifting the coordinate system (with bit 4 (LGT)
of parameter No.5002 set to 0), the programmed position,
ignoring tool offset, is displayed (with this parameter set to
1), but the programmed position, ignoring tool geometry
compensation, cannot be displayed.
- 119 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When tool geometry compensation of the T system is to be
performed by shifting the coordinate system (with bit 4 (LGn
of parameter No.5002 set to 0), the programmed position,
ignoring tool offset, is displayed (with this parameter set to
1), but the programmed position, ignoring tool geometry
compensation, cannot be displayed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l+--S-M-F--+~~-+-~~+--~--+~~-+--~-:-:-+--:-~-:--+~~-::---<
[Data type] Bit
DPF Display of the actual speed on the current position display screen,
program check screen and program screen (MD 1 mode)
0 : Not displayed
1 : Displayed
PCF Addition of the movement of the PMC--eontrolled axes to the actual speed
display
0: Added
1: Not added
NOTE
For each setting, movement along any axis other than those
controlled by the CNC (see the description of parameter No.
1010) is not reflected in the actual speed display.
NOTE
For the M series, the threading and synchronous feed option
is required to display the actual spindle speed.
SMF During simplified synchronous control, movement along a slave axis is:
(See the parameter No.8311)
0 : Included in the actual speed display
1 : Not included in the actual speed display
- 120-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0
~ 1>--~-~-:--+---+--:~-~->--~-:-~--+-S_P_D-+----+--:-:-~--+----1
[Data type] Bit
DHD Simultaneous editing of the program screens of the two paths is:
0 : Not performed.
1 : Performed.
GPL On the program list screen, the list-by-group function is:
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SPD Names for actual spindle speed values are displayed:
0 : Regardless of the selected spindle position coder
(in second position coder selection signal (PC2SLC))
1 : Depending of the selected spindle position coder
(in second position coder selection signal (PC2SLC))
SPD=O SPD=1
Spindles 1 and 2 Spindles 1 Spindles2
s S1 S2
SACT
SACT1 SACT2
ACT,S
NOTE
This parameter is enabled only when bit 2 (DPS) of
parameter No.3105 is set to 1.
- 121 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ rl-~~:~:,..-t---,:~~~~-+---+-:,,..,.,.~~:-+-~P~C~T-+---+---+-----i
[Data type] Bit
PCT On the 7-pieces type soft key display program check screen and
12-pieces type soft key display position screen, T code displayed
0 : is a T code specified in a program (T).
1 : is a T code specified by the PMC (HD. T/NX. T)
WCI On the workpiece coordinate system screen, a counter input is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
SLM The spindle load meter is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
NOTE
1 This parameter is enabled only when the DPS parameter (bit
2 of parameter No.3105) is set to 1.
2 This is valid only for serial spindles.
JSP On the current position display screen and program check screen, jog feed is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
NOTE
In manual operation mode, the jog feedrate is displayed. In
automatic operation mode, the dry run feedrate is displayed.
In each case, the feedrate to which a manual feedrate
override has been applied is displayed.
JOG F 8000 PART COUNT 15
I~ RUN TIME lHl 7M CYCLE TIME 1Hl5S
ACT.F 1000 MM/M
MEM STRT MTN *** 12:34:59
Jog/ [ l [ l l [
feedrate'-"-.------------------./
- 122-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the INH parameter (bit 2 of
parameter No. 7100) is 1.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3111 II NPA OPS OPM SVP SPS svs
[Data type] Bit
SVS Servo tuning screen
0 : Not displayed
1 : Displayed
SPS Spindle tuning screen
0 : Not displayed
1 : Displayed
SVP Synchronization errors displayed on the spindle tuning screen
0 : Instantaneous values are displayed.
1 : Peak-hold values are displayed.
OPM Operating monitor
0 : Not displayed
1 : Displayed
- 123 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
If SGD is set to 1 , no graphic display other than servo
waveform display is done.
- 124-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When the values of MSO and MS1 are changed, all preserved
external operator message history data is cleared.
#7
3114 I l~-~-1_cs_~_1u_s_~_1M_s~_1_sv_~_1o_F_~_1P_R~_1_Po~
[Data type] Bit
IPO When the [ Posl function key is pressed while the position display screen
is being displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
IPR When the ['"oo I function key is pressed while the program screen is being
displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
IOF When the [=I function key is pressed while the offset/setting screen is
being displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
ISY When the [~~1 function key is pressed while the system screen is being
displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
IMS When the [-I function key is pressed while the message screen is being
displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
ICS When the [~I (using the standard MDI) function key is pressed while
the custom screen is being displayed:
0 : The screen is changed.
1 : The screen is not changed.
- 125 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1+--~--+~~-+-~~+--~--+-N_D_F_x-+-_SF_M_x-+-_N_D_Ax--+_N_D_P_x~
L..:::_J . D10x NDFx NDAx NDPx
[Data type] Bit axis
NDPx Display of the current position for each axis
0 : The current position is displayed.
1 : The current position is not displayed.
NDAx Position display using absolute coordinates and relative coordinates is:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed. (Machine coordinates are displayed.)
SFMx In current position display, subscripts are:
0 : Added to the absolute, relative, and machine coordinate axis names.
1 : Assed only to the machine coordinate axis names.
NDFx To the actual speed display, axis movement data is:
0: Added.
1 : Not added.
NOTE
Even if the PCF parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.3105) is
set to 0, so as to add PMC controlled axis movement data
to the actual speed display, the movement data for a PMC
controlled axis for which NDFx is set to 1 is not added to the
actual speed display.
- 126-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
The value of this parameter set for path 1 is valid. The
values of loader are invalid.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3117 P9D SPP
P9D SPP SMS
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 311e I l~-~-~-~--~-~-~l_A_s_2~I_A_s~1I
[Data type] Bit
ASl to AS2 When the actual spindle speeds (SACT) of the first spindle and fourth
spindle are displayed, each value is:
0 : The value calculated based on the feedback pulses from the position
coder.
- 127 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
1 : The value calculated from the spindle motor speed (the same as the
spindle speed displayed on the operating monitor screen).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I NVG
NVG
F2K TPA
TPA
DDS
DDS
POR
POR
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
~
L:.J '--li-1m_•_fr-om_t_h_e
nosis function)o_u_tp_u_to_fa_n_a_la-rm_t_o_th_•_t•_•m-in_a_tio_n_o_f•_a_m_pl-ing_(_w_a•_•_fo_•m_d-iag__,-
- 128 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3124 DOB DO? DOS DOS D04 D03 D02 D01
3127 D25
NOTE
Set these parameters when using the display with seven soft
keys.
3131 I ~I________s_ubsc_rl_p_to_fe_ac_h_ax_is_n_am_•_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte axis
This parameter specifies a subscript (one character) of each axis name
with a code.
Set a suffix (single character) for the name of each axis by specifying a
character code.
When the loader control function is used, a suffix (single character)
specified with this parameter can be displayed after the axis name, to
indicate whether the coordinates displayed on the current position display
screen are those for controlled axes belonging to the machine or those for
controlled axes belonging to the loader.
NOTE
1 For characters and codes, see the correspondence table in
Appendix A.
2 When code O is specified, 1 or 2 is displayed.
- 129-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
3134 I I Axis display order on worlqjece coordi- system screen and worlqjece sl1ft screen I
[Data type] Byte axis
[Valid data range] 0, 1 to the number of controlled axes
This parameter specifies the order in which axes are displayed on the
workpiece coordinate system screen and workpiece shift screen (for T
series).
When the parameters of all axes are set to 0, all axes are displayed.
When the parameters of some axes are set, the axes for which a value of 0
is specified do not appear. The displayed axes are consecutive without
spaces being left for non-<lisplayed axes.
- 130 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1:-::-l f - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
LJ Machine name loader name (1st character)
1:-:::-l t - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - l
LJ Machine name loader name (2nd character)
1:-:::-l
~
Machine name loader name (3rd character)
t-----------------------l
~ t------M_ac_h_in_e_na_m_e_lo_a_de_r_na_m_e_(4_th_c_h_ar_act_e_~_ _ _ _ __,
EJ t------M_ac_h_in_e_na_m_e_lo_a_de_r_na_m_e_(5_th_c_h_ar_act_e_~_ _ _ _ __,
r-:-:::-1
~
Machine name loader name (6th character)
t-----------------------l
1:-::::-l
LJ Machine name loader name (7th character)
t-----------------------l
NOTE
1 These parameters are valid when the loader control
function is used.
2 Set the parameters for the machine and loader separately.
3 For details of character codes, see Appendix A.
[Example] When the names of machine and loader are specified as NC and
LOADER, respectively.
- 131 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
3151 Number of the axis for which the first load meter for the servo motor is used
3152 Number of the axis for which the second load meter for the servo motor is used
3153 Number of the axis for which the third load meter for the servo motor is used
3154 Number of the axis for which the fourth load meter for servo motor is used
I 3163 I ~l~~~-"-'m_e_re_q_u_ired~ro_s_m_o_m_h_th_•_•P_in_d_le_lo_ad_m_~_e_r_re_ad_in_g_s~~~-'
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] 32 ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 32
When the spindle load meter reading is displayed (see the description of
the SLM parameter (bit 6 of parameter No.3108)), smoothing can be
applied to the spindle load meter reading to prevent flickering. This
parameter sets the time width for smoothing.
Setting Tlme for smoothing (msec)
0 256
1 32
2 64
3 96
: :
32 1024
Each smoothing operation is performed for a time width of between 32ms
and 1024ms.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 3190 I .._I----''----'------'----'--H-U_N_,__ _c___ _,___ __,
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 132 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6
~ 11----+--+--F_SS_t----+~!~=!---l~W~K~l-+--+--FP_S---l
[Data type] Bit
FPS The unit function (feed per revolution) for actual cutting feedrate display
displays nwnerals of:
0 : Feedrate per minute.
1 : Feedrate per spindle revolution.
WKI On the workpiece coordinate system setting screen, the soft key [INPUT]
is:
0 : Displayed.
1 : Not displayed.
STS When data is input on the setting screen, a confirmation message is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
FSS The feedrate display is switched:
0 : In accordance with the operation state.
1 : By a DI signal.
#7 #6 #0
I 3192 I l.___ _,____,___'--T-B_2_,__TB_z___._T_RA_'--T-2_P__.__ __,
[Data type] Bit
T2P If two points are pressed on the touch panel, it is asswned that:
0 : A mid point is pressed.
1 : The first point is pressed.
NOTE
1 If two or more points are pressed during a sampling period,
it is assumed that a mid point is pressed.
2 If a C executer application or the like has a touch panel drag
(move in pressed state) function, set this parameter to 0.
3 In open CNC, the parameter is valid just for CNC screen
display function.
TRA If a point on the touch panel is kept pressed for a time specified in
parameter No. 3197 or longer,
0 : P/S alarm 5303 is not raised.
1 : P/S alarm 5303 is raised.
NOTE
1 If an C executer application or the like has a touch panel
repeat (continue pressing) function, set this parameter to 0.
2 In open CNC, the parameter is valid just for the CNC screen
display function.
- 133 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
This improvement is valid if the hardware is equipped with
a separate buzzer.
TB2 If a buzzer is provided and if bit 3 (TBZ) of parameter No. 3192 is set to 1,
0 : Pressing any point on the touch panel causes the buzzer to sound. If
any point is kept pressed, the buzzer continues sounding.
1 : The buzzer sounds when the pressing on the touch panel is recognized
as a key.
3197 I ~I____0a_tect_io_n_tim_e_of_c_o_nt_in_uo_u_s_pr_ess_in_g_on_t_ou_c_h_pa_n_e1_ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] s
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
This parameter is valid if bit 2 (TRA) of parameter No. 3192 is set to I.
Set a period of continuous pressing on the touch panel which causes
P/S5305 alarm to be raised. If 0 is set, a period of 20 s is assumed.
I a201 I l~_M_1P~_N_P_E~_N_99_~-~-P_u_o~_R_EP-~RA_L~_R_a_L~
[Data type] Bit
RDL When a program is registered by input/output device external control
0 : The new program is registered following the programs already
registered.
1 : All registered programs are deleted, then the new program is
registered.
Note that programs which are protected from being edited are not
deleted.
RAL When programs are registered through the reader/puncher interface
0 : All programs are registered.
1 : Only one program is registered.
REP Action in response to an attempt to register a program whose number is
the same as that of an existing program
0 : An alarm is generated.
1 : The existing program is deleted, then the new program is registered.
Note that if the existing program is protected from being edited, it is
not deleted, and an alarm is generated.
PUO When address 0 of a program number is output in ISO code:
0 : ":" is output.
1 : "O" is output.
N99 WithanM99block, whenbit6(NPE)ofparameterNo.3201 =0,program
registration is assumed to be:
0 : Completed
1 : Not completed
NPE With an M02, M30, or M99 block, program registration is assumed to be:
0 : Completed
1 : Not completed
- 134 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
1320211 IPSR CPD NE9 OSR CND OLV NE8
- 135 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
If this parameter is set, a protected program is also
displayed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3203 II MCL MER MZE
NOTE
When MER is set to 0, the program is deleted if the
end-of-record mark(%) is read and executed. (The mark%
is automatically inserted at the end of a program.)
#7
3204 I l.___ _,__M_K_P__._ __.__ __,___ __._E_X_K_.__ __,___PA_R__,
NOTE
The [C-EXT] soft key is used to select an operation on the
program screen. This soft key enables the entry of "(", ")",
and "@" using soft keys. This soft key is useful when using
the small MDI keyboard, which does not have the"(",")", and
"@"keys.
- 136 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
MKP When M02, M30, or EOR(%) is executed during MDI operation, the
created MDI program is:
0 : Erased automatically.
1 : Not erased automatically.
NOTE
If the MER parameter (bit 6 of parameter No.3203) is 1,
executing the last block provides a choice of whether to
automatically erase a created program.
3205 I l~M_c_K~--~--~os_c~_PN_s~_c_M_o~_c_H_G~_co_L~
[Data type] Bit
COL When a program is displayed or output, any colons (:) in the comments of
the program are:
0 : Converted to letter 0
1 : Displayed or output as is
CHG When the change function of the extended edit function is used:
0 : Once the user has decided whether to make a change, the cursor is
moved to the target position.
1 : The cursor is moved to the change source, after which the user can
choose whether to make a change.
CMO In extended tape editing, the copy or move operation:
0 : Is performed in the usual way.
1 : Can also copy or move data from a program to a key-in buffer in units
of words.
PNS On the program screen, a search by a cursor key is:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed.
OSC On the offset screen, offset value erasure by a soft key is:
0: Enabled.
1 : Disabled.
MCK The system tape memory check function is:
0: Not used.
1 : Used. (Ibis setting is inhibited.)
#7 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3206 I l~-~--~--~P_H_S~--~--~M_IF~--~
[Data type] Bit
MIF Editing of the maintenance information screen is:
0 : Not prohibited.
1 : Prohibited.
PUS The selection of an operation history signal and parameters (No. 12801 to
No. 128900) are:
0 : Not linked.
1: Linked.
- 137 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3207 I ~I--~-~--~-~--~-~--~-OM_4~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 320a I ~I--~-~--~-~--~-~-co_K~_sKY~
[Data type] Bit
SKY The function key [SYS1EM] on the MDI panel is:
0: Enabled.
1 : Disabled.
COK The automatic screen erase function is:
0: Enabled.
1 : Disabled.
NOTE
1 The setting for loader is ignored.
2 If this parameter is set to 1, screen erasure by the CAN +
FUNCTION key is enabled, irrespective of the setting of
parameter No. 3123.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3209 I ~1--~-~--~--~-~--~--~-M-PD~
[Data type] Bit
MPD When a subprogram is executed, the main program number is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
I 3210 I ~I__________Pa_ssw_o_rd_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word axis
This parameter sets a password for protecting program Nos. 9000 to 9999.
When a value other than zero is set in this parameter and this value differs
from the keyword set in parameter No.3211, bit 4 (NE9) of parameter
No.3202 for protecting program Nos. 9000 to 9999 is automatically set to
1. This disables theeditingofprogramNos. 9000to9999. Until the value
set as the password is set as a keyword, NE9 cannot be set to 0 and the
password cannot be modified.
- 138 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 The state where password .,-, 0 and password .,-, keyword is
referred to as the locked state. When an attempt is made to
modify the password by MDI input operation in this state, the
warning message 'WRITE PROTECTED" is displayed to
indicate that the password cannot be modified. When an
attempt is made to modify the password with G 10
(programmable parameter input), PIS alarm No.231 is issued.
2 When the value of the password is not 0, the parameter
screen does not display the password. Care must be taken
in setting a password.
NOTE
The value set in this parameter is not displayed. When the
power is turned off, this parameter is set to 0.
- 139 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 Set character codes according to the character code list in
Appendix A.
2 When O is set, AIAPC blinks.
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 140-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
If the setting is greater than the number of actually
connected units, MDI of the last LCD unit is selected.
NOTE
The setting cannot be changed from MDI or the like.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3290 II KEV MCM IWZ WZO MCV GOF WOF
- 141 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
WZO Setting a workpiece zero point offset value by MDI key input is:
0 : Not disabled
I: Disabled
IWZ Setting a workpiece zero point offset value or workpiece shift value
(T-series) by MDI key input in the automatic operation activation or halt
state is:
0 : Not disabled
I: Disabled
MCM The setting of custom macros by MDI key operation is:
0 : Enabled regardless of the mode.
I : Enabled only in the MDI mode.
KEY For memory protection keys:
0: The KEYi, KEY2, KEY3, and KEY4 signals are used.
I : Only the KEYl signal is used.
NOTE
The functions of the signals depend on whether KEY=O or
KEY=1.
When KEY= 0:
- KEY1 : Enables a tool offset value and a workpiece zero
point offset value to be input.
- KEY2: Enables setting data and macro variables to be input.
- KEY3: Enables program registration and editing.
- KEY4: Enables PMC data (counter and data table) to be
input.
When KEY= 1:
- KEY1 : Enables program registration and editing, and
enables PMC parameter input.
- KEY2 to KEY4: Not used
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
I 3~2 I ~l_P_K_5~-~--~-~--~-~-~-~
[Data type] Bit
PKS The KEYPRM signal (memory protection signal, parameter write
setting) is:
0 : Disabled.
I: Enabled.
- 142-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3294 II Start number of tool offset values whose input by MDI is disabled
3295 I I Nurrller of tool offset values (from the start nurrller) whose input by MDI is disabled
[Data type] Word
When the modification of tool offset values by MDI key input is to be
disabled using bit 0 (WOF) of parameter No.3290 and bit 1 (GOF) of
parameter No.3290, parameter Nos. 3294 and 3295 are used to set the
range where such modification is disabled. In parameter No.3294, set the
offset number of the start of tool offset values whose modification is
disabled. In parameter No.3295, set the number of such values.
When 0 or a negative value is set in parameter No.3294 or parameter
No.3295, no modification of the tool offset values is allowed.
When the value set with parameter No.3294 is greater than the maximum
tool offset count, no modification is allowed.
[Example]
The following setting disables the modification of both the tool geometry
compensation values and tool wear compensation values corresponding
to offset numbers 51 to 60:
Bit 1 (GOF) of parameter No.3290=1 (Disables tool offset value
modification.)
Bit 0 (WOF) of parameter No.3290=1 (Disables tool wear compensation
value modification.)
Parameter No.3294 = 51
Parameter No.3295 = 60
If bit 0 (WOF) of parameter No.3290 is set to 0, the modification of the
tool offset values alone is disabled. The tool wear compensation values
may be modified.
I 3301 I ~l_H_a_c_,_~~-'-~~'--~-'-~Hc_a___,~H-c_A_,_~~-'--Hc_c___,
[Data type] Bit
HCC In the VGA--<:ompatible mode display,
0 : A 256--<:olor bit map data of the screen hard copy is created.
1 : A 16--<:olor bit map data of the screen hard copy is created.
HCA An alarm message related to hard copy is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
HCG In a monochrome bit map,
0 : Black and white are not inverted. (same as the screen image)
1 : Black and white are inverted.
HDC A screen hard copy is:
0 : Not provided.
1 : Provided.
- 143 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.20
PARAMETERS OF
PROGRAMS ~ l,__G_s_c--+-_G_S_B--+~A-BS~t--M-A-B--+-~~-+-~~t--F-C_D--+~~-:-:~
[Data type] Bit
DPI When a decimal point is omitted in an address that can include a decimal
point
0 : The least input increment is assumed.
1 : The unit of mm, inches, or second is assumed. (Pocket calculator type
decimal point input)
FCD WhenanFcommandandaGcommand(G98,G99)forfeedperminuteor
feed per rotation are specified in the same block, and the G command
(G98, G99) is specified after the F command, the F command is:
0: Assumed to be specified in the mode (G98 or G99) when the F
command is specified
1 : Assumed to bespecifiedinthemodeoftheGcommand(G98orG99)
of the same block
NOTE
1 When FCD = 1:
If the block containing a G command (G98, G99) does not
include an F command, the last F command specified is
assumed to be specified in the G command mode of the
block.
Example
N1 G99;
N2 Faaaa G98 ; - Faaaa is assumed to be specified in the
G98 mode.
N3 Fbbbb ; - Fbbbb is assumed to be specified in the
G98 mode.
N4 G99 ; - Fbbbb is assumed to be specified in the
G99 mode.
2 In G code system B or C, G98 and G99 function are specified
in G94 and G95.
NOTE
ABS is valid when MAB, #4 of parameter No.3401, is set to 1.
- 144-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ 1>--:-:-:--+-~-~-:-+----+----+--:-:-:-+--G-19->--G-1-8--+-:-~-:_,
[Data type] Bit
GOl Mode entered when the power is turned on or when the control is cleared
0 : GOO mode (positioning)
I : GO! mode (linear interpolation)
G 18 and G 19 Plane selected when power is turned on or when the control is cleared
G19 G18 G17, G18 or G19 mode
0 0 G17 mode (plane XY)
0 1 G18 mode (plane ZX)
1 0 G19 mode (plane VZ)
#7 #1 #0
3403 I l~--+--Ao_2--+_c_1R_~--+---~--~--+---~
[Data type] Bit
CIR When neither the distance (I, J, K) from a start point to the center nor an arc
radius (R) is specified in circular interpolation (G02, G03):
0 : The tool moves to an end point by linear interpolation.
I : P/S alarm No.022 is issued.
AD2 Specification of the same address two or more times in a block is:
0 : Enabled (Next specification is enabled.)
I : Disabled (P/S alarm No.5074)
NOTE
1 When 1 is set, specifying two or more G codes of the same
group in a block will also result in an alarm being issued.
2 Up to three M codes can be specified in a single block, when
bit 7 (M3B) of parameter No.3404 is set to 1.
- 145 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
M3B EOR M02 M30 SBP POL
M3B EOR M02 M30 SBP POL NOP
- 146-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ l>--QA~B--+~a_L_G-+-~D_DP~>--c_c_R--+~G-3_6-+-~PP_S~>--~-:-~--+~:-~-~_,
NOTE
This parameter is valid when bit 7 (QAB) of parameter
No.3405 = 0.
QAB When the passing-point signal output function is used, address ",Q"
specifies:
0 : Remaining distance to be traveled
1 : Coordinate value of the longest axis
- 147 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
C07 C05 C04 C03 C02 C01
C07 C05 C04 C03 C02 C01
C16
C19 C1B C17 C16
CFH
CFH
NOTE
When the set value is 0, the difference of radii is not checked.
In the HPCC mode, a check is made for a difference in the arc
radius even if the set value is "O" (with allowable limit = 0).
- 148 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3411 I ~I________M_cod_e_p_rev_e_nt_i_ng_b_u_ffe_n_·n_g_1_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
3412 I ~I________M_co_d_e_p_rev_e_n_ti_ng_b_u_ffe_n_·n_g2-------~
3413 I ~I________M_co_d_e_p_re_ve_n_ti_ng_b_u_ffe_ri_n_g3-------~
3420 I ~l________M_c_o_d_e_pr_ev_e_n1_in_g_bu_ff_e_rin_g_1_0_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
Set M codes that prevent buffering the following blocks. If processing
directed by an M code must be performed by the machine without
buffering the following block, specify the M code.
MOO, MO!, M02, and M30 always prevent buffering even when they are
not specified in these parameters.
NOTE
1 The specification of a minimum value that exceeds the
specified maximum value is invalid.
2 When there is only one data item, set the following: minimum
value = maximum value.
- 149-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l..._B_D_X--+~~--+-~~-+--N_P_S--+~~-~-~--+-~~-+-~~-+--A-U_P_,
[Data type] Bit
A UP When a command for the second miscellaneous function contains a
decimal point or negative sign:
0 : The command is invalid.
1 : The command is valid.
NOTE
For the T series, a decimal point and negative sign are
supported for commands for the second miscellaneous
function, regardless of the setting made with this parameter.
CQD The method used for detennining the amount of travel in circular
interpolation is:
0 : Series 16 type.
1 : Series 15 type.
NPS A block that contains M98 Pxxx or M99, and which contains no addresses
other than 0 and N functions:
0 : As a one-block NC statement involving no movement.
(A single-block stop is caused.)
1 : As a macro statement.
(A single-block stop is not caused. Moreover, the block is not
regarded as a block involving no movement in tool-tip radius
compensation mode.)
BDX A decimal point specified with address B is handled:
0 : 1n the conventional way.
1 : 1n the same way as in a system equipped with the second auxiliary
function.
1n a system without second auxiliary function, the decimal point specified
with address B can be handled as in a system equipped with the second
auxiliary function. The following parameters can be used:
• Bit 0 (AUP) of parameter No. 3450
• Bit 0 (AUX) of parameter No. 3405
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1>--~--+~~--+-~~-+--N-B-N--+~C-C-K--+-~SD-P~>--~--+~G-QS---1
[Data type] Bit
GQS When G33 is specified, the threading start angle shift function (Q) is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
SDP The function to specify an S command with decimal point is:
0: Not used.
1: Used.
An S command with one decimal place can be specified. However, the S
command value is rounded off to the nearest whole number.
- 150-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l>-----+---+----+----+---+--->-----+-C_R_D_,
B
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
l+----+--+----+--+----+--+----+-AX-D---1
- 151 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401
is set to 0.
2 Because some addresses (such as Rand K) are not related
to an axis, setting this parameter for all axes is not equivalent
to setting bit O (DPI) of parameter No. 3401 to 1.
..
~ r1~~~~~~Ad~d~,-~ro-rs-e-co-nd~m~isc-.~lla_n_eo_u_s7fu-nci~io-n~~~~~--j
[Data type] Byte
This parameter specifies the address used for the second miscellaneous
function, as follows:
Address A B C U V W
Set value 65 66 67 85 86 87
Address B is assumed when a value other than the above is set.
Axes names cannot be used to specify the address.
- 152-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.21
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARAMETERS OF
PITCH ERROR ~ lf-----+---+---+--+---+---f--E_P_C--+----1
COMPENSATION
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ ~1---+---+---1-----+---+---+----+--B_D_P_,
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
The function of both-direction pitch error compensation is
required.
~ ~-N_u_m_be_ro_r_th_•_pi_tc_h
L.::.J _ each axis _•'_'°_'c_o_m_pe_n_••-ti-on_po_•H-io_n_fo_rt-h-e_'er_"_'"_"ce_p_os-it-io_nr_o_r~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
153 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Set the number of the pitch error compensation position for the reference
position for each axis.
3 --' ,-,L_I
I
2 --
--, I
1
I
I
l _ _J I
I
Pitch error compensation
I I
R~:erence position l__~ position (number)
l _ _J
I
L _ _J -2
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 154-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 155 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 156-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
+3 ·I- ,----,
I I
+2 l_J L--,
I
r--
Reference position ~ I I
+1 I L_I I
.1
'
'
'
'
'
'
'
'
I .' ''
I
' ' I
-4001
I
-300 -200 -100
,----_J
I
I
+-1
0 100 200 I_____
300 II 400 (m~)
I I
L--, l ___ _J ·I- -2
I I
L--, I -3
I I
L _ _J
-4
- 157 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Reference position
45.0
(61)
(62)(
90.0 (+)
(63)
(64)
135.0
180.0
+3 Reference position
----, +2 ----,
I I I I
I I
I L_--, +1 I L_I
I I I I Machine coordinate
-4
- 158 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3625 Travel distance per revolution in pitch error compensation of rotation axis type
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
If 0 is set, the travel distance per revolution becomes 360
degrees.
EJ 626
l-
NOTE
_N_u_m_b•_•_o1_p_itch_••_•o_r_co_m_p_•n_sa_t_io_n
direction (for movement in the negative _po-in_t•-1-th_•_'•_rt_h•-•1_•_nd_i_n_th_•_neg-•1-iv_•_--l
direction)
NOTE
1 For a movement in the positive direction, set the
compensation point number at the farthest end in the
negative direction in parameter No. 3621 .
2 A set of compensation data items for a single axis should not
be set to lie astride 1023 and 3000.
- 159-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
Number of pitch error compensation point in the reference position if pitch error
compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour control on the slave side
during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first spindle)
3661
Number of pitch error compensation point in the reference position if pitch error
compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour control on the slave side
during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second spindle)
3662
Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the negative
direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first
3666 spindle)
Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the negative
direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second
3667 spindle)
- 160-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the positive
direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first
3671 spindle)
Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the positive
direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second
3672 spindle)
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 161 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis
of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple
synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave
axis (bit 1 of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1).
2 The number of the compensation point at the farthest end in
the negative direction for a movement in the positive
direction is set in parameters No. 3666 to No. 3669.
3 A set of compensation data items for a single axis cannot be
set to lie astride 1023 and 3000 or astride 2599 and 5599.
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 162-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an
axis of Cs contour control on the slave side during simple
synchronous spindle control is carried out just on the slave
axis (bit 1 of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1).
- 163 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.22
PARAMETERS OF ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
#7 ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ #1 ~
I 3701 I l~-~--~-~-s_s_2~--~-~-1s_1~-~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
ISi The serial interface for the first and second spindles are:
0: Used.
1 : Not used.
NOTE
This parameter is valid when the spindle serial output option
is provided. It is used when the CNC is started with serial
interface control for the first and second serial spindles
disabled temporarily (for example, for CNC startup
adjustment). Usually, it should be set to 0.
If this parameter is set to 1 when using the serial spindle and
analog spindle at the same time, the analog spindle is set the
first axis.
NOTE
This parameter is valid, when the spindle serial output option
is provided and parameter ISl(bit 1 of parameter No.3701)is0.
1 Confirmation of connection of the second serial spindle
amplifier, and communication with it
2 Control of the second spindle during asynchronous
control (SIND2)
The spindle synchronization function and simplified spindle
synchronization function require that two serial spindles be
connected in advance. Before using these functions,
ensure that this parameter is set to 1 (the parameter is not
set automatically).
When this parameter is set, it is also necessary to set the
serial spindle parameter for the second spindle.
- 164-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3102 I l+-----+----+---+-----+--o_R2--+_o_R_1- + - - - + - - - - +
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l+-----+----+---+-----+--M_PP--+---+---+----+
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
If this parameter is set to 1, set parameters No. 3781 to No.
3782 as well.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3704 I ._I_c_s_s_,__ _-'-_s_s_v_.__s_s_s_,__ _-'----'----'----'
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 165 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
The master axis and slave axis of simple synchronous spindle control can
be selected from the first to second spindles.
The target spindle of simple synchronous spindle control is set in
parameters No. 4821 to No. 4822.
In addition, the following signals affect the control.
Signal of simple synchronous control of each spindle
ESSYCl to ESSYC4 <G264 bits 0 to 3>
Parking signal of simple synchronous control of each spindle
PKESEI to PKESE4 <G265 bits 0 to 3>
CSS On the second spindle, Cs contour control is:
0 : Not performed.
1 : Performed.
NOTE
1 A single spindle cannot be specified as multiple axes of Cs
contour control.
2 This parameter cannot be used with the spindle positioning
function. When using the spindle positioning function, set bit
7 (CSS) of parameter No. 3704 to 0.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1t--~--+----,S~FA=-+-~N~sF=-t--E-V_S--+----,S~G~T-+--=-sG~B=-t--G~S~T,--t----,:~:~:--1
[Data type] Bit
ESF When the spindle control function (Spindle analog outpu or Spindle serial
output) is used, and the constant surface speed control function is used or
bit 4 (GTI') of parameter No.3705 is set to 1:
0 : S codes and SF are output for all S commands.
1 : S codes and SF are not output for an S command in constant surface
speed control mode (G96 mode) or for an S command used to specify
maximum spindle speed clamping (GSOS-;).
- 166-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
For the T series, this parametar is enabled when bit 4 (EVS)
of parameter No.3705 is set to 1.
For the M series, SF is not output:
(1) For an S command used to specify maximum spindle
speed clamping (G92S-;) in constant surface speed
control mode
(2) When bit 5 (NSF) of parameter No.3705 is set to 1
NOTE
If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
(GIT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
invalid.
NOTE
The output of S codes and SF for an S command in constant
surface speed control mode (G96), or for an S command
used to specify maximum spindle speed clamping
(G50S-;) depends on the setting of bit 0 (ESF) of
parameter No.3705.
- 167 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~ l+--~-~-:--+--~-=-~--+-~-:~-+--G-TT-+----+---+--:-:-:--+-::-:--+
[Data type] Bit
PG2 and PGl Gear ratio of spindle to position coder
Magnification PG2 PG1
X1 0 0
Namber of spindle revolutions
x2 0 1 Magnification=------~------
NOTE
1 The gear selection method differs as described below. For
details, refer to the description of spindle control in the
connection manual (function part).
Type M:
The CNC determines a proper gear from the parameter
setting and S command value, and requests the PMC to
specify the gear and its switching.
In addition, spindle control is exercised according to a
gear selected by the CNC.
Type T:
The CNC exercises spindle control according to a gear
selected by the PMC.
2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
type T is selected, regardless of whether this parameter is
specified.
3 When type T spindle gear switching is selected, the following
parameters have no effect:
No.3705#2 SGB, No.3751, No.3752, No.3705#3 SGT,
No.3761 , No.3762, No.3705#6 SFA, No.3735, No.3736
On the other hand, parameter No. 3744 becomes usable for
ordinary spindle control.
- 168 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3707 I l~--+---~--~--+---~--~P_2_2~_P_21~
[Data type] Bit
P22 and P21 Gear ratio of spindle to second position coder
Magnification P22 P21
x1 0 0
Number of spindle revolutions
X2 0 1 Magnification=------~------~
NOTE
This parameter is valid when the multi-spindle control option
is selected.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ ~
~ l>-----+-~-:-~-+--:~--+--s_v_o--+---+----+--s_A_"--+-:-:-:_,
[Data type] Bit
SAR The spindle speed arrival signal is:
0 : Not checked
1: Checked
SAT Check of the spindle speed arrival signal at the start of executing the
thread cutting block
0 : The signal is checked only when SAR, #0 of parameter 3708, is set.
1 : The signal is always checked irrespective of whether SAR is set.
NOTE
When thread cutting blocks are consecutive, the spindle
speed arrival signal is not checked for the second and
subsequent thread cutting blocks.
SVD When the SIND signal is on, the detection of spindle speed fluctuation is:
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SOC During constant surface speed control (G96 mode), the speed clamp by
the maximum spindle speed clamp command (l\t: series: G92 S_; T series:
G50 S_;) is carried out:
0 : Before spindle speed override.
1 : After spindle speed override.
If this parameter is set to 0, the spindle speed may exceed the maximum
spindle speed (numeric value following Sin G92 S_; (M series) or G50
S_; (T series)).
If this parameter is set to 1, the spindle speed is limited to the maximum
spindle speed.
The spindle speed is limited to the upper limit of spindle speed specified
in parameter No. 3772, irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
- 169-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
During rigid tapping, the override is tied to 100%,
irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ 1f--~--+~~-+~~-+~S~M~C--+~M_R_S-+~M_s_1-+~:~:~~--+~S_AM---I
[Data type] Bit
SAM The sampling frequency to obtain the average spindle speed
0 : 4 (Nonnally, set to 0.)
1: 1
RSC In the constant surface speed control mode, the surface speed of a rapid
traverse block is calculated:
0 : In accordance with the coordinates of the end point.
1 : In accordance with the current value, as in cutting feed.
MSI In multi-spindle control, the SIND signal is valid
0: Only when the first spindle is valid (SIND signal for the 2nd, 3rd
spindle becomes ineffective)
1 : For each spindle irrespective of whether the spindle is selected (Each
spindle has its own SIND signal).
MRS When the S 12-bit code signals and actual spindle speed signals are
output in multi-spindle control:
0: Signals common to the first and second spindles are used In tbis case,
information about a spindle selected by the spindle selection signal
(SWS 1-SWS3«l027#0--#2>) and SWS4<G026#3>) is output
1: Information about each of the first and second spindles is output on
individual signals.
Signal When MRS is When MRS is
settaO set ta 1
S 12-bit code signals First spindle (SWS1 = 1) First spindle
R01 O-R120<F036,F037> Second spindle
Actual spindle speed signals (SWS1=0, SWS2 = 1)
ARO-AR15<F040,F041>
S 12-bit code signals 2 - Second spindle
R0102-R1202<F200,F201 >
Actual spindle speed signals 2
AR200-AR215<F202,F203>
NOTE
1 To use this parameter, the multi-spindle control option and
serial spindle option are required.
2 To use the actual spindle speed signals, the actual spindle
speed output option is required.
- 170-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
If a spindle gear ofM type is selected, this function compares the specified
S value and the settings of parameters No. 3741toNo.3743 and raises an
alarm if the S value is greater.
If this function is used, specifying an S value larger than the settings of
parameters No. 3741 to No. 3743 causes PIS alarm 5310 to be raised.
NOTE
This function cannot be used together with any of bit 4
(GIT) of parameter No. 3706, constant surface speed
control.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
3715 I l~-~--~--~-~--~--~-~-N_S_Ax~
[Data type] Bit axis
NSAx This parameter specifies an axis for which confirmation of the spindle
speed reached signal (SAR) is unnecessary when a move command is
executed for the axis. When a move command is issued only for an axis
for which 1 is set in this parameter, the spindle speed reached signal
(SAR) is not checked.
0 : Confirmation of SAR is necessary.
1 : Confirmation of SAR is unnecessary.
I 3730 I ~I__o_at_au_s_ed_fo_r_ad_iu_st_in_g_th_eg_a_in_of_th_e_a_na_log_ou_tp_u_tof_s_p_in_dle_s_p_ee_d_~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] 0.1 %
[Valid data range] 700 to 1250
Set data used for adjusting the gain of the analog output of spindle speed.
[Adjnstment method]
(1) Assign standard value 1000 to the parameter.
(2) Specify the spindle speed so that the analog output of the spindle
speed is the maximum voltage (10 V).
(3) Measure the output voltage.
(4) Assign the value obtained by the following equation to parameter
No.3730.
Set value= _ _ _l_O~(~V~)- - x 1000
Measured data (V)
(5) After setting the parameter, specify the spindle speed so that the
analog output of the spindle speed is the maximum voltage. Confirm
that the output voltage is lOV.
NOTE
This parameter needs not to be set for serial spindles.
- 171 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
l;;l ~eo_m_p•_n_••_ti_on_•_•l_u•_f_or-1h_•_o_ff•_•_tv_o_11a_g_•of-th_•_•n_•_lo_g_out_p_ut_of_th_•_•p_in_d_I•-~
~_speed
NOTE
This parameter usually need not to be set for serial spindles
(Set to O).
r-;;-1 ~-T-he_•_p_ind_l•_•_pe_ed_d_ur-in_g_sp-in_d_l•_or-ie-nta_t_io_n_or-th_•_•_pi-nd-le_m_o_to_r_•p_ee_d--~
L.:.:J _ during spindle gear shift
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 0 to 20000
Set the spindle speed during spindle orientation or the spindle motor
speed during gear shift.
When GST, #1 of parameter 3705, is set to 0, set the spindle speed during
spindle orientation in rpm.
When GST, #1 of parameter 3705, is set to 1, set the spindle motor speed
during spindle gear shift calculated from the following formula.
For a serial spindle
Spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift
Set value= x 16383
Maximum spindle motor speed
For an analog spindle
Spindle motor speed during spindle gear shift
Set value= x4095
Maximum spindle motor speed
- 172-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
B ~1-----M-i-ni-mu_m_c_la-m-ps_p_ee_d_o~f~-.-.-pi-nd-le_m_o_ro_r_ _ _ _---1
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 0 to 4095
Set the minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor.
Minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor
Set value= x4095
Maximum spindle motor speed
NOTE
If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
(GIT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
invalid.
B -----M-ax_i_m-um_c_la_m_p-sp_ee_d_of_t_he-s-pi-nd-le_m_o_to-r- - - - - - - 1
1-l
NOTE
If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
(GIT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
invalid.
In this case, the maximum clamp speed of spindle motor
cannot be specified. However, the maximum spindle speed
can be specified by the following parameters.
Parameter No.3772 (for the first axis)
Parameter No.3802 (for the second axis)
- 173 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
3740 I ~I___li_1m_e_e_1aps_ed_p_ri_or_to_c_h_-_·n_g_th_e_s_pi_nd_le_s_pe_ed_a_rr_iv_a1_s_ig_na_1_ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] msec
[Valid data range] 0 to 225
Set the time elapsed from the execution of the S function up to the
checking of the spindle speed arrival signal.
EJ
[Data type] Two-word
Maximum spindle speed for gear 4
(Note)
- 174-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
If a type-T gear shift scheme is selected for the M series
(with the constant surface speed control option installed or
parameter GIT (bit 4 of parameter No. 3706) = 1),
parameter No. 3744 is usable also in the M series.
Note, however, that, even in this case, only up to three main
gear stages are usable for rigid tapping.
~ >--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-I
~ Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 1 to gear 2
~
L.::J t--~~---,--,-.,,.-~~~.,..--,~---,...,..,----,~~--,-~---,,--~~---1
Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3
- 175 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
/ I II I // I
Spindle motor max. clamp speed ----./-+----r-+--· Parameter No.3736
I I I I I
Speed at gear 2"""'1 change point -----1---r-- ---r:; ----1- Parameter No.3752
I I I I
/ I I I I
Speed at gear 1-2 change point
I ___ I _____ I _ Parameter No.3751
1 1
I I I
)/ I I I
//I I I I
/ I I I I
Spindle motor minimum clamp ,L,1.:---t---t---r-------t- Parameter No.3735
speed I~/ I I I I I
? I I I I I
Spindle speed
I Gear 1 I command
I max. I Gear2 Gear3
(Scommand)
I max. max
I speed speed speed
I parameter I parameter parameter
I No.3741 I No.3742 No.3743
I I
I I
I I
t
Gear 1-2
change point '
Gear2-3
change point
B
[Data type] Word
Spindle speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3 during tapping
- 176-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
/I /I // I
Spindle motor max. -----1--+---,--f----r---+
clamp speed I I I I
(Parameter No.3736) I I I I
1
I I
/ I I
I
I
I
I
// I I I I
Spindle motor minimum
~~--,--~---1-----1-
clamp speed 1 I I
(Parameter No.3735) I I I
1 < - - - + - - ' - - - - I - - - - ' - - - - - - - - ' - - - - - - - ' • Spindle speed
GMeaxar_ 1
1 : Gear 2 Gear 3 command
1
Max. Max. (S command)
1
I speed speed speed
I Parameter I Parameter Parameter
I No.3741 : No.3742 No.3743
.I
Gear 1-2
~
Gear2-3
change point change point
parameter parameter
No.3761 No.3762
Flg.4.22 (d) Spindle Motor Speed at Gear 1-2124 Change Point during Tapping
NOTE
When 0 is set, constant surface speed control is always
applied to the X-axis. In this case, specifying P in a G96
block has no effect on the constant surface speed control.
- 177 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
3n2 I ~l________M_~_im_u_m_~_i_nd_le_s_pe_ed_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] min-I
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
This parameter sets the maximum spindle speed.
When a command specifying a speed exceeiling the maximum speed of
the spindle is specified , or the speed of the spindle exceeds the maximum
speed because of the spindle speed override function, the spindle speed is
clamped at the maximum speed set in the parameter.
NOTE
1 For M series, this parameter is valid if the function of constant
surface speed control is provided.
2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
the spindle speed is clamped at the maximum speed,
regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode is specified.
3 When O is set in this parameter, the speed of the spindle is
not clamped.
4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the spindle speed is
not clamped.
5 When the multi-spindle control option is selected (T series),
set the maximum speed for each spindle in the following
parameters:
Parameter No.3772: Sets the maximum speed for the first
spindle.
Parameter No.3802: Sets the maximum speed for the
second spindle.
r-::::-1
LJ P code for selecting the first spindle in mulU-spindle control
t-----------------------<
1::1
LJ P coda for selecting the second spindle in multi--spindle control
t-----------------------i
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 178 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703
issetto1.
2 If this parameter is set to 0, the corresponding spindle
cannot be selected by a P code.
3 Identical P code values cannot be used for different
spindles. (Identical P code values cannot be used even if the
paths are different.)
4 If this parameter is used (bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703
is set to 1), signals SWS1 to SWS2 <G027 bits 0 to 1>
become invalid.
5 To use this parameter, the multi-spindle control function is
needed.
~ ~1------M-~_im_u_m_spe_ed_o_r1_he_s_eco_nd_s_pi_nd_I•_ _ _ _ ___,
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid when the multi-spindle control option
is selected.
2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
the spindle speed is clamped at the specnied maximum speed,
regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode is specified.
3 When this parameter is set to 0, parameter No. 3772
(maximum speed of the first spindle) is valid. The spindle
speed is not clamped when parameter No. 3772 is set to 0.
4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the spindle speed is
not clamped.
r-:::-1
LJ Maximum spindle speed for gear 1 of the second spindle
>------------------------<
r-:::1
LJ Maximum spindle speed for gear 2 of the second spindle
>------------------------<
- 179-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
These parameters are used for the multi-spindle control.
1::-1 Data for adjusting the gain of the analog output of the third-spindle speed
~ t--------------------------1
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] 0.1 %
[Valid data range] 700 to 1250
Set the data used for adjusting the gain of the analog output of the third
spindle speed.
NOTE
This parameter is used for controlling the multi-spindles.
LJ '--------------------------'
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Velo
[Valid data range] -1024 to 1024
Set the offset-voltage compensation value of the analog output of the
third-spindle speed.
NOTE
This parameter is used for controlling the multi-spindles.
~ ~1-------M_ax_i_m_um_s_p_ee_d_m_t_he_t_hi_m_s_pi_nd_le_ _ _ _ _ __,
- 180 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid when the multi-spindle control option
is selected.
2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
the spindle speed is clamped at the specified maximum
speed, regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode
is set.
3 When O is set in this parameter, the setting of parameter
No.3772 for the first spindle is used. When 0 is set in
parameter No.3772, the spindle speed is not clamped.
4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the speed of the
spindle is not clamped.
r-::::-1
LJ Maximum spindle speed for gear 1 of the third spindle
>-----------------------<
r:::l
LJ Maximum spindle speed for gear 2 of the third spindle
>-----------------------<
NOTE
These parameters are used for the multi-spindle control.
- 181 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Table 4.22 (a) Parameters for Control of Serial Interface Spindle Cs Contouring Control Axis
No. Data type Description
3900 Byte First group Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
the set values of parameters 3901 to 3904 when the Cs contouring axis is
controlled (set values 0 to 8)
3901 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 1 selection
3902 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 2 selection
3903 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 3 selection
3904 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 4 selection
3910 Byte Second group Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
the set values of parameters 3911 to 3914 when the Cs contouring axis is
controlled (set values Oto 8)
3911 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 1 selection
3912 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 2 selection
3913 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 3 selection
3914 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 4 selection
3920 Byte Third group Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
the set values of parameters 3921 to 3924 when the Cs contouring axis is
controlled (set values Oto 8)
3921 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 1 selection
3922 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 2 selection
3923 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 3 selection
3924 Word Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
spindle gear 4 selection
<Setting method>
First, select servo axes which perform interpolation with the Cs
contouring axis. (Up to three axes can be selected.)
When there is no servo axis for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis,
set the parameters 3900, 3910 and 3920 to 0 to terminate parameter
setting.
When there are servo axes for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis,
the parameters must be set according to the procedure below for each axis.
(1) Set the number of a servo axis (1 to 4) for interpolation with the Cs
contouring axis in parameters 39n0 (n = 0, 1 and 2).
(2) Set loop gain values of the servo axis specified in (1) above which is
used when the Cs contouring axis is controlled in parameters 39nl,
39n2, 39n3, and 39n4. (There are four stages for main gears used.)
(3) When the number of specified servo axes is less than 3, set the
remaining parameters (39n0) to 0 to terminate parameter setting.
When the number of a Cs contouring axis is set to parameter 39n0,
the parameter is assumed to be set to 0.
- 182 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 In general, it is difficult to set a high loop gain for a spindle
motor axis when compared with a servo axis. These
parameters are provided so that, by changing the loop gain
of a servo axis that requires interpolation with the Cs contour
axis, interpolation control can be exercised correctly
between the Cs axis and servo axis while the spindle
exercises Cs contour control.
2 The loop gain of the servo axis is changed using the
parameter settings made for a spindle gear selected at the
time of conversion from the spindle mode to the Cs contour
control mode.
In normal use, it is unlikely that the gear of the spindle is
switched during Cs contour control. However, note that if the
gear of the spindle is changed during Cs contour control, the
loop gain of the servo axis is not changed.
3 Even when multiple Cs axis (bit 7 (CSS) of parameter No.
3704 = 1) is used, these parameters are shared.
- 183 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 184 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters to be used II the spindle switch function Is not used or to be used tor
the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
(No.4000 to 4135)
4040 Word Normal velocity loop proportional gain (HIGH)
4041 Word Normal velocity loop proportional gain (LOW)
4042 Word Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (HIGH)
4043 Word Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (LOW)
4044 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
4045 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
4046 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
4047 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
4048 Word Normal velocity loop integral gain (HIGH)
4049 Word Normal velocity loop integral gain (LOW)
4050 Word Velocity loop integral gain during orientation (HIGH)
4051 Word Velocity loop integral gain during orientation (LOW)
4052 Word Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
4053 Word Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
4054 Word Velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
4055 Word Velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
4056 Word Gear ratio (HIGH)
4057 Word Gear ratio (MEDIUM HIGH)
4058 Word Gear ratio (MEDIUM LOW)
4059 Word Gear ratio (LOW)
4060 Word Position gain during orientation (HIGH)
4061 Word Position gain during orientation (MEDIUM HIGH)
4062 Word Position gain during orientation (MEDIUM LOW)
4063 Word Position gain during orientation (LOW)
4064 Word Position gain change ratio when orientation is completed
4065 Word Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
4066 Word Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (MEDIUM HIGH)
4067 Word Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (MEDIUM LOW)
4068 Word Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
4069 Word Position gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
4070 Word Position gain in Cs contour control (MEDIUM HIGH)
4071 Word Position gain in Cs contour control (MEDIUM LOW)
4072 Word Position gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
4073 Word Grid shift amount in servo mode
4074 Word Reference position return speed in Cs contour/servo mode
4075 Word Orientation completion signal detection level
4076 Word Motor velocity limit value during orientation
4077 Word Orientation stop position shift amount
4078 Word MS signal constant
4079 Word MS signal gain adjustment
- 185 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
No. Data type Parameters to be used II the splndle switch function Is not used or to be used tor
the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
(No.4000 to 4135)
4080 Word Conventional: Regenerative power limit
HRV: Regenerative power limit in high-speed area/Regenerative power limit
4081 Word Delay time prior to motor power shut-<>11
4082 Word Acceleration/deceleration time setting
4083 Word Motor voltage during normal rotation
4084 Word Motor voltage during orientation
4085 Word Motor voltage in servo mode/spindle synchronization
4086 Word Motor voltage in Cs contour control
4087 Word Over-speed level
4088 Word Excessive velocity deviation detection level when the motor is constrained
4089 Word Excessive velocity deviation detection level when the motor is rotated
4090 Word Overload detection level
4091 Word Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in the servo mode
4092 Word Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in Cs contour control
4093 Word Load meter displayed value for maximum output (low-speed winding)
4094 Word Disturbance torque compensation constant
4095 Word Speed meter output voltage adjustment value
4096 Word Load meter output voltage adjustment value
4097 Word Spindle velocity feedback gain
4098 Word Maximum speed at which position coder signal can be detected
4099 Word Delay time for energizing the motor
4100 Word Conventional:Base velocity of the motor output specification
HRV:Base velocity of the motor output specification
4101 Word Conventional:Output limit value for the motor output specification
HRV:Torque limit value for the motor output specification
4102 Word Conventional:Base speed
HRV:Excitation voltage saturation speed under no load
4103 Word Conventional:Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
HRV:Base speed limit ratio
4104 Word Conventional:Current loop proportional gain
HRV:Current loop proportional gain
4105 Word Conventional:Current loop proportional gain (in Cs contour control)
HRV:Reserved
4106 Word Conventional:Current loop integral gain
HRV:Current loop integral gain
4107 Word Conventional:Current loop integral gain (in Cs contour control)
HRV:Reserved
4108 Word Conventional:Current loop integral gain zero speed
HRV:Current loop integral gain zero speed
4109 Word Conventional:Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
HRV:Filter time constant when the specified voltage is saturated
- 186 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters to be used II the spindle switch function Is not used or to be used tor
the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
(No.4000 to 4135)
4110 Word Conventional:Current conversion constant
HRV:Current conversion constant
4111 Word Conventional:Secondary current factor for exciting current
HRV:Secondary current factor
4112 Word Conventional:Current expectation constant
HRV:Level for determining the saturation of specified voltage/PWM command clamp val-
ue
4113 Word Conventional:Slip constant
HRV:Slip constant
4114 Word Conventional:High-speed rotation slip compensation constant
HRV:Slip compensation factor in high-speed area/Slip compensation factor during decal-
eration
4115 Word Conventional:Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
HRV:PWM command clamp value during deceleration
4116 Word Conventional:Electromotive force compensation constant
HRV:Motor leak constant
4117 Word Conventional:Electromotive force phase compensation constant
HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high-speed area in steady state/Motor voltage fao-
tor in steady state
4118 Word Conventional:Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high-speed area during acceleration/Motor voltage
factor during acceleration
4119 Word Conventional:Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
HRV:Time constant for changing the exciting current during deceleration
4120 Word Conventional:Dead zone compensation data
HRV:Voltage without rectangular wave componenVDead zone compensation data
4121 Word Time constant for changing the torque
4122 Word Velocity detection filter time constant
4123 Word Short-term overload detection time
4124 Word Conventional:Voltage compensation factor during deceleration
HRV:Reserved
4125 Word
4126 Word
4127 Word Conventional:Load meter displayed value for maximum output
HRV:Load meter displayed value for maximum output
4128 Word Conventional:Maximum output limit zero speed
HRV:Maximum torque curve compensation factor
4129 Word Conventional:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
HRV:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
4130 Word Conventional:Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during decel-
eration
HRV:Velocity factor for the proportional gain of the current loop/Current phase lag com-
pensation constant
- 187 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
No. Data type Parameters to be used II the splndle switch function Is not used or to be used tor
the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
(No.4000 to 4135)
4131 Word lime constant of the speed detection filter (in Cs contour control)
4132 Word Conversion constant of the phase--V current
4133 Word Motor model code
4134 2Word
4135 2Word Grid shift amount in Cs contour control
No. Data type Parameters for low-<ipeed characteristics if the s~indle switch function is not used
or if the output switch function is used on the MA N spindle when the spindle is
switched
(No.4136 to 4175)
4136 Word Motor voltage during normal rotation
4137 Word Motor voltage in servo mode/spindle synchronization
4138 Word Conventional:Base velocity of the motor output specification
HRV:Base velocity of the motor output specification
4139 Word Conventional:Output limit value for the motor output specification
HRV:Torque limit value for the motor output specification
4140 Word Conventional:Base speed
HRV:Excitation voltage saturation speed under no load
4141 Word Conventional:Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
HRV:Base speed limit ratio
4142 Word Conventional:Current loop proportional gain
HRV:Current loop proportional gain
4143 Word Conventional:Current loop integral gain
HRV:Current loop integral gain
4144 Word Conventional:Current loop integral gain zero speed
HRV:Current loop integral gain zero speed
4145 Word Conventional:Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
HRV:Filter time constant when the specified voltage is saturated
4146 Word Conventional:Current conversion constant
HRV:Current conversion constant
4147 Word Conventional:Secondary current factor for exciting current
HRV:Secondary current factor
4148 Word Conventional:Current expectation constant
HRV:Level for determining the saturation of specified voltage/PWM command clamp val-
ue
4149 Word Conventional:Slip constant
HRV:Slip constant
4150 Word Conventional:High-speed rotation slip compensation constant
HRV:Slip compensation factor in high-.,;peed area/Slip compensation factor during decel-
eration
4151 Word Conventional:Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
HRV:PWM command clamp value during deceleration
- 188 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters for low-speed characteristics II the s~lndle switch function Is not used
or ii the output switch function is used on the MA N spindle when the spindle is
switched
(No.4136 to 4175)
4152 Word Conventional:Electromotive force compensation constant
HRV:Motor leak constant
4153 Word Conventional:Electromotive force phase compensation constant
HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high-<1peed area in steady state/Motor voltage fao-
tor in steady state
4154 Word Conventional:Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high-<1peed area during acceleration/Motor voltage
factor during acceleration
4155 Word Conventional:Voltage compensation factor during deceleration
HRV:Reserved
4156 Word Temperature compensation gain
4157 Word lime constant for changing the torque
4158 Word Conventional:Maximum output limit zero speed
HRV:Maximum torque curve compensation factor
4159 Word Conventional:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
HRV:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
4160 Word Hysteresis of the speed detection level
4161 Word Conventional:Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during decel-
eration
HRV:Velocity factor for the proportional gain of the current loop/Current phase lag com-
pensation constant
4162 Word Cutting feed velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
4163 Word Cutting feed velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
4164 Word Conversion constant of the phase-V current
4165 Word Conventional:Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
HRV:lime constant for changing the exciting current during deceleration/Time constant
for changing the exciting current
4166 Word Conventional:Regenerative power limit
HRV:Regenerative power limit in high-<1peed area/Regenerative power limit
4167 Word
4168 Word Overload current alarm detection level (for low-speed characteristics)
4169 Word Overload current alarm detection time constant
4170 Word Overload current alarm detection level (for high speed characteristics)
4171 Word Number of teeth of spindle gear (HIGH)
4172 Word Number of teeth of position detector gear (HIGH)
4173 Word Number of teeth of spindle gear (LOW)
4174 Word Number of teeth of position detector gear (LOW)
4175 Word Analog override zero level
- 189 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
No. Data type Parameters for SUB spindle II the spindle switch function Is provided
(No.4176 to 4283)
4176 Bit Bit parameter
4177 Bit Bit parameter
4178 Bit Bit parameter
4179 Bit Bit parameter
4180 Bit Bit parameter
4181 Bit Bit parameter
4182 Bit Bit parameter
4183 Bit Bit parameter
4184 Bit Bit parameter
4185 Bit Bit parameter
4186 Bit Bit parameter
4187 Bit Bit parameter
4188 Bit Bit parameter
4189 Bit Bit parameter
4190 Bit Bit parameter
4191 Bit Bit parameter (Cannot be changed by the user. See Note 1.)
4192 Bit Bit parameter
4193 Bit Bit parameter
4194 Bit Bit parameter
4195 Bit Bit parameter (For setting parameters automatically. See Note 2.)
4196 Word Maximum motor speed
4197 Word Speed arrival detection level
4198 Word Speed detection level
4199 Word Speed zero detection level
4200 Word Torque limit value
4201 Word Load detection level 1
4202 Word Output limit pattern
4203 Word Output limit value
4204 Word Position coder method orientation stop position
4205 Word Spindle orientation speed
4206 Word Normal velocity loop proportional gain (HIGH)
4207 Word Normal velocity loop proportional gain (LOW)
4208 Word Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (HIGH)
4209 Word Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (LOW)
4210 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode (HIGH)
4211 Word Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode (LOW)
4212 Word Normal velocity loop integral gain
4213 Word Velocity loop integral gain during orientation
4214 Word Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode
4215 Word
4216 Word Gear ratio (HIGH)
4217 Word Gear ratio (LOW)
- 190-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters for SUB spindle II the spindle switch function Is provided
(No.4176 to 4283)
4218 Word Position gain during orientation (HIGH)
4219 Word Position gain during orientation (LOW)
4220 Word Position gain change ratio when orientation is completed
4221 Word Position gain in servo mode (HIGH)
4222 Word Position gain in servo mode (LOW)
4223 Word Grid shift amount in servo mode
4224 Word
4225 Word
4226 Word Orientation completion signal level
4227 Word Motor velocity limit value during orientation
4228 Word Orientation stop position shift amount
4229 Word MS signal constant
4230 Word MS signal gain adjustment
4231 Word Regenerative power limit
4232 Word Delay time prior to motor power shut--011
4233 Word Acceleration/deceleration time setting
4234 Word Spindle load monitor observer gain 1 (on the SUB side)
4235 Word Spindle load monitor observer gain 2 (on the SUB side)
4236 Word Motor voltage during normal rotation
4237 Word Motor voltage during orientation
4238 Word Motor voltage in servo mode
4239 Word Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in the servo mode
4240 Word Feed forward coefficient
4241 Word Velocity loop feed forward factor
4242 Word
4243 Word Number of teeth of spindle gear (HIGH)
4244 Word Number of teeth of position detector gear (HIGH)
4245 Word Number of teeth of spindle gear (LOW)
4246 Word Number of teeth of position detector gear (LOW)
4247 Word Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for high-speed charac-
teristics on the MAIN side)
4248 Word Spindle load monitor torque constant (for high-speed characteristics on the MAIN side)
4249 Word Spindle load monitor observer gain 1 (on the MAIN side)
4250 Word Spindle load monitor observer gain 2 (on the MAIN side)
4251 Word Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for low-<1peed charac-
teristics on the MAIN side)
4252 Word Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for high-speed charac-
teristics on the SUB side)
4253 Word Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for low.....peed charac-
teristics on the SUB side)
4254 Word Temperature compensation gain (for high-speed characteristics on the SUB side)
4255 Word Temperature compensation gain (for low.....peed characteristics on the SUB side)
4256 Word Base velocity of the motor output specification
- 191 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
No. Data type Parameters for SUB spindle II the splndle switch function Is provided
(No.4176 to 4283)
4257 Word Output limit value for the motor output specification
4258 Word Base speed
4259 Word Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
4260 Word Current loop proportional gain
4261 Word Current loop integral gain
4262 Word Current loop integral gain zero speed
4263 Word Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
4264 Word Current conversion constant
4265 Word Secondary current factor for exciting current
4266 Word Current expectation constant
4267 Word Slip constant
4268 Word High-speed rotation slip compensation constant
4269 Word Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
4270 Word Electromotive force compensation constant
4271 Word Electromotive force phase compensation constant
4272 Word Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
4273 Word lime constant for changing the torque
4274 Word Load meter displayed value for maximum output
4275 Word Maximum output limit zero speed
4276 Word Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
4277 Word Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during deceleration
4278 Word Velocity detection filter time constant
4279 Word Load meter displayed value at maximum output (low-speed winding)
4280 Word lime constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
4281 Word Spindle load monitor torque constant (for low-..peed characteristics on the MAIN side)
4282 Word Spindle load monitor torque constant (for high-speed characteristics on the SUB side)
4283 Word Spindle load monitor torque constant (for low-speed characteristics on the SUB side)
- 192-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters for low-...peed characteristics when the output switch function Is used
on the SUB spindle side ii the spindle switch function is provided
(No.4284 to 4351)
4284 Word Motor voltage during normal rotation
4285 Word Motor voltage in servo mode
4286 Word Base velocity of the motor output specification
4287 Word Output limit value for the motor output specification
4288 Word Base speed
4289 Word Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
4290 Word Current loop proportional gain
4291 Word Current loop integral gain
4292 Word Current loop integral gain zero speed
4293 Word Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
4294 Word Current conversion constant
4295 Word Secondary current factor for exciting current
4296 Word Current expectation constant
4297 Word Slip constant
4298 Word High-speed rotation slip compensation constant
4299 Word Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
4300 Word Electromotive force compensation constant
4301 Word Electromotive force phase compensation constant
4302 Word Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
4303 Word lime constant for changing the torque
4304 Word Maximum output limit zero speed
4305 Word Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
4306 Word Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during deceleration
4307 Word Regenerative power limit
4308 Word lime constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
4309 Word Motor model code
4310 2Word
4311 2Word
4312 Word Position coder method orientation end signal detection level 2 (MAIN)
4313 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 1 (MAIN)
4314 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 2 (MAIN)
4315 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation stop position shift amount (MAIN)
4316 Word Position coder method orientation end signal detection level 2 (SUB)
4317 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 1 (SUB)
4318 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 2 (SUB)
4319 Word Magnetic sensor method orientation stop position shift amount (SUB)
4320 Word Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/HIGH)
4321 Word Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/MEDIUM HIGH)
4322 Word Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/MEDIUM LOW)
4323 Word Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/LOW)
4324 Word Motor deceleration time constant (SUB/HIGH)
- 193 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
No. Data type Parameters for low-speed characteristics when the output switch function Is used
on the SUB spindle side ii the spindle switch function is provided
(No.4284 to 4351)
4325 Word Motor deceleration time constant (SUB/LOW)
4326 Word Deceleration time constant limit start speed (MAIN/HIGH)
4327 Word Deceleration time constant limit start speed (SUB/HIGH)
4328 Word Position coder-based spindle orientation command multiplication (MAIN)
4329 Word Position coder-based spindle orientation command multiplication (SUB)
4330 Word Deceleration time constant limit start speed (MAIN/LOW)
4331 Word Deceleration time constant limit start speed (SUB/LOW)
4332 Word
4333 Word
4334 Word Number of arbitrary pulses of speed detector (MAIN)
4335 Word Number of arbitrary pulses of speed detector (SUBJ
4336 Word Change point for spindle synchronous acceleration/deceleration time constant
4337 Word Velocity compensation factor for velocity loop gain (MAIN)
4338 Word Velocity compensation factor for velocity loop gain (SUBJ
4339 Word Torque clamp level
4340 Word Belkhaped acceleration/deceleration time constant for spindle synchronization
4341 Word Abnormal load detection level
4342 Word
4343 Word
4344 Word Look-ahead feed forward coefficient
4345 Word Spindle motor speed command detection level
4346 Word Incomplete integral coefficient
4347 Word Detection level for spindle 1-to-2 speed difference at slave operation
4348 Word Overload current alarm detection level (for low-speed characteristics)
4349 Word Overload current alarm detection time constant
4350 Word Overload current alarm detection level (for high-<1peed characteristics)
4351 Word Compensation for current detection offset
No. Data type Parameters tor the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched and the like
(No.4352 to 4372)
4352 Bit Bit parameter
4353 Bit Bit parameter
4354 Word
4355 Word MZ sensor signal amplitude ratio compensation
4356 Word MZ sensor signal phase difference compensation
4357 Word BZ sensor signal amplitude ratio compensation
4358 Word BZ sensor signal phase difference compensation
4359 Word
4360 Word
4361 Word Number of arbitrary pulses of position detector
4362 Word
- 194-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
No. Data type Parameters for the MAIN spindle when the spindle Is switched and the like
(No.4352 to 4372)
4363 Word
4364 Word
4365 Word
4366 Word
4367 Word
4368 Word
4369 Word
4370 Word
4371 Word
4372 Word Safe rotation speed
No. Data type Parameters tor the SUB spindle when the spindle Is switched and the like
(No.4373 to 4393)
4373 Bit Bit parameter
4374 Bit Bit parameter
4375 Word Shift amount in synchronous control of the spindle phase
4376 Word
4377 Word
4378 Word
4379 Word
4380 Word
4381 Word
4382 Word
4383 Word
4384 Word EGB automatic phasing maximum speed
4385 Word EGB automatic phasing acceleration/deceleration time constant
4386 Word Number of sinusoidal waves of position detector of the master spindle
4387 Word Numerator of EGB synchronization ratio
4388 Word Denominator of EGB synchronization ratio
4389 Word
4390 Word
4391 Word Center frequency of vibration suppression filter
4392 Word Frequency width of vibration suppression filter
4393 Word
- 195 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 Among the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface, parameters Nos. 4015
and 4191 cannot be changed by the users.
These parameters require to assign optional software to the CNC and are automatically set
depending on the type of the software.
2 To set the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface automatically, set #7 of
parameter No.4019 (if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use
parameter No.4195) to 1, assign the model code of the motor to be used to parameter No.4133
(if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use parameter No.4309),
turn off the power of the CNC and spindle amplifier, and restart the CNC and spindle amplifier.
3 Parameters No.4000 to No.4539 are used in the processing on the spindle amplifier. See
FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR a series PARAMETER MANUAL (B-65150E).
4 The CNC can control up to two spindle amplifiers with the serial interface.
Up to three spindle amplifiers can be controlled in the Series 16 performing single-path control.
When the spindle control amplifier provides the spindle switching function, one spindle amplifier
can control two spindle motors using the switching function.
The output switching function can be used in spindle motors to be connected.
Up to four spindles, or eight types, can be used by switching the spindle motors. (The number
of spindles that can controlled simultaneously is the same as the number of spindle amplifiers,
that is two spindles.)
Parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface correspond to the above functions
as follows:
(1) Parameter No.4000 to No.4539 "S1 ": First spindle amplifier
Parameter No.4000 to No.4539 "S2": Second spindle amplifier
(2) Parameter No.4000 to No.4175 "S1 "/"S2": When the spindle switching function is not
provided, or for the main spindle in the spindle amplifier when the function is provided.
Parameter No.4176 to No.4351 "S1 "/"S2": For the sub spindle in the spindle amplifier when
the spindle switching function is provided.
(3) Parameters at low speed when the output switching function is provided.
Parameters No.4136 to No.4175 "S1 "/"S2": When the spindle switching function is not
provided, or for the main spindle when the function is provided.
Parameters No.4284 to No.4351 "S1 "/"S2": For the sub spindle when the spindle switching
function is provided.
5 The CNC stores the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface. The CNC sends
them to the spindle amplifier at the system power on and they are used in the unit.
These parameters are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier in a batch when:
- The CNC is switched on.
- The serial spindle is restarted by a reset that is carried out after spindle communication
alarm 749 occurs (because the spindle control unit is switched off or because of noise).
If these parameters are rewritten, they are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier
sequentially when:
- The parameters have been entered from the MDI.
- The parameters have been entered as programmable (G10).
- The parameters have been entered via the reader/punch interface.
To set parameters automatically, upload parameters corresponding to the motor model from
the spindle amplifier to the CNC prior to the procedure specified above.
The parameters of the spindle amplifier with serial interface can be changed after the
system starts. Changing the parameters (No.4000 to No.4539 "S1 ", "S2") in the CNC sends
them to the spindle amplifier at an appropriate time and the parameters in the unit are
updated. Be careful not to change parameters incorrectly.
6 It takes 1000 ms for the new parameters to take effect on the spindle amplifier side.
- 196-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4800 I l~s_P_K~_E_P_z~--~--~--~--~N_o_2~_N_o_1~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
Error pulse between two spindles when synchronizing phases in the serial
spindle synchronization control mode
a
[Data type] Word
Allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the serial
spindle synchronization control mode or simple synchronous control mode
- 197 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Set the allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in
the serial spindle synchronization control mode or simple synchronous
control mode.
NOTE
This parameter is used to output the inter-spindle phase
error detection signal SYCAL in the serial spindle
synchronization control mode. The SYCAL <F044#4>
signal becomes "1" when a phase error exceeding the value
set in this parameter is found.
When you are going to use this parameter to detect error
pulses during simplified synchronization control, pay
attention to the mode of the spindle, and set the parameter
as required. (The parameter is invalid in spindle mode. It is
valid in Cs contour control, rigid tapping, and spindle
positioning mode; the detection unit per pulse differs,
however.)
4821 Master axis of first spindle under simple synchronous spindle control
4822 I ~I__M_a_s_te_rax_is_of_s_ec_o_nd_•_Pi_nd_le_u_n_de_r_si_m_p1_e_sy_nch_ro_n_ou_s_sp_in_d_le_c_on1_r_o1_~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before oparation is continued.
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704
issettol.
2 After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
back on for the setting to become effective.
a 4826
Permissible synchronization error under simple synchronous spindle control in
which the first spindle is the slave axis
~---------~
B 4827
198 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set a pennissible error of error pulse between two spindles in the mode of
simple synchronous spindle control. The data unit is the unit of the
detector used meanwhile.
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704
issettol.
2 This parameter is used to output the signals of synchronous
error detection under synchronous spindle control SYCAL 1
to SYCAL2 <F043 bits 0 to 1>.
3 Under simple synchronous spindle control in the spindle
mode, no synchronization error is detected.
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid if bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704
issettol.
2 After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
back on for the setting to become effective.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ l+-----+----+---+-----+----+---+-----+-FL_R---<
- 199-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ 911
NOTE
Unit of data depends on parameter No.4900#0 FLR.
Set the ratio (q) of the spindle speed which is assumed to be the specified
spindle speed in the spindle speed fluctuation detection function.
Let the commanded speed be Sc. When the actual spindle speed reaches
between (Sc-Sq) and (Sc+ Sq), it is assumed to be the commanded speed.
The spindle speed fluctuation detection starts.
NOTE
Unit of data depends on parameter No.4900#0 FLR.
Set the spindle speed fluctuation ratio (r) for which no alarm is activated in
the spindle speed fluctuation detection function (see Fig.4.22 (e)).
0
LJ4913
1--S-pi-nd-le_s_pe_e_d-flu_ctu_au-·o_n_va_iu_e_(d_)_fo_•w_h_ic_h_no_a_l•_•_m_is_•_ct_iva-te_d_in_t_he
spindle speed fluctuation detection function _ __,
-200-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Spindle speed
Sm
-~--- ......- - - - - - - - - - - Specified
speed
Sm
Actual speed
No___._ _ _ Check
Check
check
Command Check Alarm
another start
speed
LJ
Q4914
l--li-1m_e_(p_)_e1_aps_ed_f_ro_m_w_h_en_1_he_c_o_m_m_an_d_ed_s_p_ind-le_s_pe_ed_is_c_ha_n_ged-10_1_he---l
start of spindle speed fluctuation detection
--:-t------------------------ Sm
Sm
Specified
speed
Actual speed
No Check
check
~--~--~-------~--------+Time
Command Check Alarm
another start
speed
- 201-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~ l...__IM_B--+~E_S_l--+-~TRV~-+-~~-+-~~+--ISZ~-+--1-D_M--+~IO_R__,
NOTE
The extended specification includes the following two
extensions:
(1) With the conventional specification, the number of M
codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle is
always 6. With the extended specification, an arbitrary
number of such M codes from 1 to 256 can be selected
by parameter setting (See parameter No.4964.)
(2) The maximum feedrate for spindle positioning (setting of
parameter No.1420) can be extended from 240000 to
269000 (in increments of 10 deg/min).
-202-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
In the case of half-fixed angle posmoning based on M codes,
three types of spindle positioning operations can occur:
(1) The spindle rotation mode is cleared, then the mode is
switched to the spindle positioning mode.
(2) Spindle positioning is performed in the spindle
positioning mode.
(3) The spindle positioning mode is cleared, then the mode
is switched to the spindle rotation mode.
In the case of specifiection A:
Operations (1) to (3) are specified using separate M codes.
(1) Specified using M codes for performing spindle
orientation.
(See parameter No.4960)
(2) Specified using M codes for specifying a spindle
positioning angle. (See parameter No.4962)
(3) Specified using M codes for clearing spindle positioning
operation. (See parameter No.4961.)
In the case of specification B:
When M codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle are
specified, operations (1) to (3) are performed successively.
(See parameter No.4962.)
~ ~1~~~~~-M_c_od_•_•P_~_ify_i_ng_1_h•_•_Pi_nd_le_o_rie_nra_u_·o_n~~~~~~
r-:::-1
~
M code releasing the spindle positioning mode
>--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
LJ
r-:::'l ,_________________,
M code for specifying a spindle positioning angle
- 203 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
M
'
(a+n)
'
(n+ 1) 0
'
NOTE
IJ represents the basic angular displacement set in
pamrameter No.4963.
This parameter sets the number of M codes used for Half-fixed angle
positioning using M codes.
As many M codes as the number specified in this parameter, starting with
the M code specified in parameter No.4962, are used to specify half-fixed
angle positioning.
Let a be the value of parameter No.4962, and let ~ be the value of
parameter N o.4964. That is, M codes from Ma to M (a+(>-1) are used for
half-fixed angle positioning.
-204-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid when bit 6 (ESI) of parameter
No.4950=1.
2 Make sure that M codes from Ma to M (a+j}-1 ) do not
duplicate other M codes.
3 Setting this parameter to O has the same effect as setting 6.
That is, M code from Ma to M (a+S) are used for half-fixed
angle positioning.
~ ~1~~~~~~~S_•_~_o_1o_o_p_ga_in_o_11_h•_•_P_in_dl_•~~~~~~---1
r-::::-1
~
Servo loop gain multiplier of the spindle for gear 1
f--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~---1
r-:::-1
~
Servo loop gain multiplier of the spindle for gear 2
>--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~--!
r-:::-1
~
Servo loop gain multiplier of the spindle for gear 3
f--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~---1
r-::::-1
~
Servo loop gain multiplier of the spindle for gear 4
f--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~--1
NOTE
The above parameters No.4970 to No.4974 are for analog
spindles.
- 205 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.23
PARAMETERS OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
TOOL
COMPENSATION ~ 1>--~--+~E-V-O-+-~TP-H~>--E-V-R--+~1-A-L-+-~O-FH~>--T-L-B--+~T-LC---1
[Data type] Bit type
TLC Tool length compensation
0 : Tool length compensation A or B (Conforms to TLB in parameter
No.5001)
1 : Tool length compensation C
TLB Tool length compensation axis
0 : Always Z axis irrespective of plane specification (Tool length
compensation A)
1 : Axis perpendicular to plane specification (G17, Gl8, andG19) (Tool
length compensation B)
OFH Offset number of tool length compensation, cutter compensation and tool
offset
0 : Specifies the tool length compensation using an H code, and cutter
compensation C using a D code
Tool offset conforms to TPH in parameter No.5001#5.
1 : Specifies the tool length compensation, cutter compensation and tool
offset using H codes
TAL Tool length compensation C
0 : Generates an alarm when two or more axes are offset
1 : Not generate an alarm even if two or more axes are offset
EVR When a tool compensation value is changed in cutter compensation C
mode:
0 : Enables the change, starting from that block where the next D or H
code is specified.
1 : Enables the change, starting from that block where buffering is next
performed.
TPH Specifies whether address D or H is used as the address of tool offset
number (G45 to G48).
O:Dcode
l:Hcode
TPH is valid when OFH in parameter No.5001#2 is 0.
EVO Specifies whether an offset is effective in the next block to be buffered or
the next block for which an H code is specified when the offset value is
changed in tool length offset A or B.
0 : Next block in which an H code is specified.
1 : Next block to be buffered.
-206-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ l>--W_N_P--+~LW~M-+-~LG_C~>--L_G_T--+~~-+-~LWT~-+--L_G_N--+~L-D_1_,
NOTE
When the option of tool geometry/wear compensation is
equipped and LGT = 0, the offset is done in a T code block
regardless of this parameter.
WNP Imaginary tool tip direction used for tool nose radius compensation, when
the geometry/wear compensation option is equipped, is the direction
specified by:
0 : Geometry offset number
1 : Wear offset number
- 2ITT -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ ~1-T_G_c___.~~-~-~-+~~-+-~~-+-~~+--~-~~~+--s-u_v___.~S-U_P_,
[Data type] Bit
SUP Start up or cancel in cutter compensation C
0: Type A
l:TypeB
SUV When G40, G41, and G42 are specified independently,
0 : The start up and cancel operation conforms to the standard
specification.
1 : Moves by a distance corresponding to the offset vector which is
vertical to the next block movement. Specifying G40 alone results in
the offset cancel operation.
CCN When automatic reference position return (G28) is specified in the cutter
compensation C mode (M series) or in tool nose radius compensation (T
series):
0 : The tool nose radius compensation vector is cancelled in movementto
an intermediate position.
1 : The tool nose radius compensation vector is not cancelled in
movement to an intermediate position, but is cancelled in movement
to the reference position.
LVC Offset value of tool offset
0 : Not cleared, but held by reset
1 : Cleared by reset
LVK Tool length offset value
0 : Cleared by reset
1 : Not cleared, but held by reset
TGC Tool geometry compensation value
0 : Not canceled by reset
1 : Canceled by reset
(Valid when LVC, #6 of parameterNo.5003, is "1")
#0
~ lt--Y_03~~1~~--+-~~-+-~~-+--T_s_1--+-~0-D-l-+--o_R_C--t~~-1
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 208 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ 1>--~--+~~-+-~~-+-~~-+-~~+-~~>--T_G_C--t~~-:~---1
[Data type] Bit
OIM When the unit is switched between the inch and metric systems, automatic
tool offset value conversion is:
0 : Not performed
1 : Performed
NOTE
If this parameter setting is changed, reset the tool offset
data.
-209-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
0 : Performed
1 : Not performed
CNC During interference check for cutter compensation C (M series) or
tool-tip radius compensation (T series), when the direction of movement
after application of the offset differs from the programmed direction by
between 90° and 270°:
0 : An alarm is issued.
1 : No alarm is issued.
G39 The corner rounding function (G39) in cutter compensation C mode is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
CNV The interference check and vector erasure of cutter compensation C (M
series) or tool-nose radius compensation (T series) are:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed.
MCR If G41/G42 (cutter compensation C (M series) or tool-nose radius
compensation (T series)) is specified in the MDI mode, an alarm is:
0 : Not raised.
1 : Raised. (P/S5257)
NOTE
In the MDI mode, cutter compensation C (M series) or
tool-nose radius compensation (T series) is not performed,
irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
~-+-~C B
-~S;;;ta;;.rt· point
Do A
End point
Center
- 210-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
[FS15 format]
B
End ·n1
Center
NOTE
The setting of this parameter determines the travel distance
determination method for circular interpolation not during
cutter compensation C (M series) or tool-nose radius
compensation (T series) as well. Accordingly, if this
parameter is set, the setting of bit 3 (COD) of parameter No.
3450 is invalid.
GCS If G49 (G code for canceling tool length compensation) and G40 (G code
for canceling cutter compensation) are specified in a single block, the tool
length compensation is cancelled:
0 : In the next block.
1 : In the specified block.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 211 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
Limitvaluethatignores the vector when a tool moves on the outside of a corner during
tool nose radius compensation
Limit value that ignores the vector when a tool moves on the outside of a corner
during cutter compensation C
Programmed path
'···.... .....··
5013 I ~I______M_ax_i_m_um_va_1u_e_o_rto_o_1_w_ea_r_co_m_pe_ns_a_tio_n_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-B IS-C Units
Millimeter input 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch input 0.0001 0.00001 inch
- 212-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Set the maximum allowable value for the tool wear compensation value,
input as an incremental value. If the incremental input value (absolute value)
exceeds the set value, the following alarm or warning message is output:
Input from MDI Warning: Setting value out of range.
Input using GIO PIS alarm No.032: Offset value is out of range by
GIO.
a
[Data type] 2-word
Distance {ZM) betweeen reference position and Z axis- contact surface
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter input 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch input 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
- 213 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~-~--------------------iQ mesurement
reference
Xm position
X-axis -<:ontact face
'
Z-axis +contact~
face .._ Z-axis -contact face
+X ~zm-
t
Flg.4.23 Distance along X and Z Axes from the Reference Position to+/- Contact Surfaces
1::-1
~
Tool offset number used for the input of tool offset value measured B
t-----------------------1
a ~I-N_u_rrt>er
__ __pno-·_'ID_co_ntacti_·_ng_tha_ID_uch_se_nsor_~
of_pu_lse-inlB_rpolali_·_on_cyc_les_me_mo_rized
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the TS1 parameter (bit 3 of
parameter No.5004) is set to 1.
- 214-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 215 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.24
PARAMETERS OF
CANNED CYCLES
4.24.1
Parameter of Canned #7
NOTE
In the case of the T series, this parameter is valid only for the
drilling canned cycle in the Series 10/11 format.
EXC GS!
0 : Specifies a drilling canned cycle
1 : Specifies an external operation connnand
RTR G83 and G87
0 : Specify a high-speed peck drilling cycle
1 : Specify a peck drilling cycle
ILV Initial point position in drilling canned cycle
0 : Not updated by reset
1 : Updated by reset
RD2, RDl Set the axis and direction in which the tool in drilling canned cycle G76 or
G87 is got free. RD2 and RD! are set as shown below by plane selection.
- 216-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#0
~ l>---RD_l--+~RA~B-+-~K_OE~>--R_F_C--+~F-1_6-+-_a_s_R~>--M_R_C--+~~-l
NOTE
This parameter is valid for multiple repetitive turning canned
cycle type I.
QSR Before a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G70 to G73) is started, a check
to see if the program contains a block that has the sequence number
specified in address Q is:
0: Not made.
1 : Made. (If the sequence number specified in address Q cannot be
found, an alarm occurs and the canned cycle is not executed.)
F16 When the Series 10/11 format is used (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter
No.0001 set to 1), a canned drilling cycle is specified using:
0 : Series 10/11 format
1 : Series 21 format. (However, the number of repetitions is specified
using address L.)
RFC For the semifinish figure of G7 l or G72 and for a cutting pattern of G73,
tool-nose radius compensation is:
0 : Not performed.
1 : Performed.
KOE When KO is specified in a hole machining canned cycle (GSO to G89):
0 : Hole machining is performed once.
1 : Hole machining is not performed. Instead, the hole machining data is
merely memorized.
RAB The R command forthe drilling canned cycle in the Series 10/11 format is:
0 : Regarded as an incremental command
1 : Regarded as:
An absolute command in the case of G code system A
An absolute command in the case of G code system B or C when the
G90 mode is specified.
An incremental command in the case of G code system B or C when
the G91 mode is specified.
RDI The R command for the drilling canned cycle in the Series 10/11 format:
0 : Is regarded as the specification of a radius
1 : Follows the specification of a diameter/radius for the drilling axis
- 217 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #0
~ 1>--~--+~~-~-~--+-~~-+-~~-+--P_N_A--+-~P-15~>--~-F-D--+~S-IJ--1
[Data type] Bit
SIJ When the FS 10/11 command format is used, a tool shift value for the
drilling canned cycle G76 or G87 is specified by:
0: Address Q
1 : Address I, J, or K
TFD During a threading cycle, feed forward is:
0: Enabled.
1 : Disabled.
QZA When the specification of the depth of cut (Q) for each time is omitted, or
ifQO is specified in a high-speed peck drilling canned cycle (G73) or peck
drilling canned cycle (G83):
0 : No alarm is issued.
1 : An alarm (No.045) is issued.
PIS When the FS 10/11 command format is used, the machining sequence for
pocketing using multiple repetitive canned cycle G71 or G72 follows:
0 : FS21 (FS16) specification
1 : FS 10/11 specification
PNA If the FSl0/11 tape format is used and if a plane without an axis is
specified in the canned cycle mode of drilling, an alarm is:
0 : Raised. (P/S 028)
1 : Not raised.
TCZ In a tapping cycle (excluding rigid tapping), an accumulated zero check in
the tapping step (forward, backward) is:
0 : Not performed.
1 : Performed.
Execute a tapping cycle (excluding rigid tapping) with the servo feed forward
(bit I of parameter No. 2005). If an impact is detected, set this parameter to I.
#7 #2 #1 #0
~ 1>--~--+~~--+-~~-+-~~-+-~~+--FC_K~r-B_C_R--t~~-1
- 218 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 The machining profile is checked before the operation of the
canned cycle (not during machining).
2 The machining profile to be checked is a programmed
profile. The path of retraction or return is not checked.
3 This parameter is not valid for G71 or G72 of the canned
cycle for grinder.
~ r l_ _ _ _ _ c-ax
__i_sc_la_m_p_M_c_o_de_i_nd_n_·m_ng_c_a_nn_e_d_cy_d_e_ _ _ ___,
r-:::-1 > - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
LJ Dwell time when C-axis unclamping is specified in drilling canned cycle
r-:::'l > - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
LJ Spindle forward-rotation M code in drilling canned cycle
NOTE
M03 is output when "O" is set.
r-:::'l > - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
LJ Spindle revers&--rotation M code in drilling canned cycle
- 219-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
M04 is output when "O" is set.
V---~
q : Depth of cut
d : Return value
---.~-+------- Rpoint
q
d
q
t d
~, : Zpoint
For T series this parameter sets the return or clearance value in drilling
canned cycle G83.
V---~' V---~'
q : Depth of cut q : Depth of cut
d : Reb.un value d : Clearance value
R point R point
+ t ''
•' • •'
q ' q ' ' '
: d '
'
' '
' ' ~ '
'
T T
: + '
: d '
'
'
: '
'
'
' ~
'
'
'
'
•' •'
' '
q ' q '
' '
- ---- '
' --- - '
'
t'
'
Zpoint -. '
' Zpoint
-220-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ ~1------~c~1.-.-ra-nce-m~c-an_n_ed-cy-cl-e~GB3----------l
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter input 0.01 0.001 0.001 mm
Inch input 0.001 0.0001 0.0001 inch
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
This parameter sets the clearance of peck drilling cycle G83.
q : Depth of cut
V--- .. '
d : Clearance value
Rpoint
tq +' t :
' ' '
•t
q
' '
'
' '
~ ''
'
''
''
+ ' ~ '
''
tq
'
• ...
. .,
'
''
'' Zpoint
l:'::-1
LJ Override value for retraction in boring cycle (G85, G89)
f-------------------------1
- 221-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.24.2
Parameter of Thread
Cutting Cycle
a 5130
Chamfering distance in the thread cutting cycles G76 and G92
t-----------------------1
~---------------------~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] 0.1 pitch
[Valid data range] 0 to 127
This parameter sets the chamfering in the thread cutting cycles G76 and
G92.
~ ~1-------C_ha_m_fe_r_ing_a_n_gl_e_in_th_re_a_di_ng_cy_c_le_ _ _ _ _ __,
4.24.3
Parameter of Multiple
Repetitive Canned
a
5132
DepthotcutinmultiplerepetHive cannedcyclesG71 andG72
t-----------------------1
~---------------------~
Cycle [Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data]
Increment system 15-B 15-C Unit
Millimeter input 0.001 0.001 mm
Inch input 0.0001 0.0001 inch
r-:::"l
LJ Escape in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72.
f------------------------1
-222-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
a
[Data type] 2-word
Escape in multiple repetitive canned cycle G73 in Z--axis direction
[Unit of data]
Increment system 15-B 15-C Unit
Input in mm 0.001 0.001 mm
Input in inches 0.0001 0.0001 inch
B
[Data type] 2-word
Division count in multiple repetitive canned cycle G73
~ ~1~~~~~-R_m_ur_n_in_m_u_H_ip_le_can~n_ed_cy~cl_es_G_7_4_a_n_d_G_75~~~~~--1
- 223 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
1:-::-1
LJ Finishing allowance in the multiple repetitive canned cycle G76
t-----------------------1
r-:-:::-1 Repetition count of final finishing in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76
~ f--------------------------1
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] Cycle
[Valid data range] 1 to 99999999
This parameter sets the repetition count in multiple repetitive canned
cycle G76.
r-:-:::-1
~
Tool nose angle in multiple repetitive canned cycle G76
t-----------------------1
4.24.4
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1
Parameters of Peck
Drilling Cycle of a ~ rl---+---+---t-----;---+-N-O-L-+--0-L_S__,_ __,
Small Diameter
[Data type] Bit
OLS When an overload torque signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a
small diameter, the feed and spindle speed are
0 : Not changed.
1: Changed.
NOL When the depth of cut per action is satisfied although no overload torque
signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter, the feed and
spindle speed are:
0 : Not changed.
1: Changed.
-224-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
B
[Data type] 2-word
M code that specifies the peck drilling cycle mode of a small diameter
EJ
[Data type] Byte
Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed when the tool is retracted after
an overload torque signal is received
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 1 to 255
This parameter sets the percentage of the spindle speed to be changed
when the tool is retracted because the overload torque signal is received in
a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter.
S2 = Sl x dl + 100
S 1: Spindle speed to be chaged
S2: Spindle speed changed
dl is set as a percentage.
EJ
[Data type] Byte
Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed when the tool is retracted with-
out an overload torque signal received
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 1 to 255
This parameter sets the percentage of the spindle speed to be changed
when the tool is retracted without the overload torque signal received in a
peck drilling cycle of a small diameter.
S2 = Sl x d2 + 100
S 1: Spindle speed to be chaged
S2: Spindle speed changed
d2 is set as a percentage.
EJ
[Data type] Byte
Percentage of cutting feed rate to be changed when the tool is retracted after an
overload torque signal is received
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 1 to 255
This parameter sets the percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed
when the tool is retracted because the overload torque signal is received in
a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter.
F2 = Fl x bl + 100
Fl: Cutting feedrate to be changed
F2: Changed cutting feedrate
b 1 is set as a percentage.
- 225 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
[Data type] Byte
Percentage of the cutting feed rate to be changed when the tool is retracted
without an overload torque signal received
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 1 to 255
This parameter sets the percentage of the cutting feedrate tot be changed
when the tool is retracted without the overload torque signal received in a
peck drilling cycle of a small diameter.
F2=Fl x b2 + 100
Fl: Cutting feedrate to be changed
F2: Changed cutting feedrate
b2 is set as a percentage.
EJ
[Data type] Byte
Lower limit of the percentage of the cutting feed rate in a peck drilling cycle of a
small diameter
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
This parameter sets the lower limit of the percentage of the cutting
feedrate changed repeatedly in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter to
the specified cutting feedrate.
FL=F Xb3 +100
F: Specified cutting feedrate
FL: Changed cutting feedrate
Set b3 as a percentage.
EJ
[Data type] Word
Number of the macro variable to which the total number of retractions during
cutting is output
NOTE
The total number cannot be output to common variables 500
to 531.
-226-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
[Data type] Word
Number of the macro variable to which the total umber of retractions because of
an overload signal is output
NOTE
The total number cannot be output to common variables 500
to 531.
B
[Data type] Word
Speed of retraction to point R when no address I is issued
EJ
[Data type] Word
Speed of advancing to the position just before the bottom of a hole when no
address I is issued
- 227 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.25
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
RIGID TAPPING SRS FHD DOV SIG CRG VGR GB4
FHD PCP DOV SIG CRG VGR GB4
NOTE
For serial spindles, set this parameter to 0 when using the
DMR function for position coder signals on the spindle side.
CRG Rigid mode when a rigid mode cancel command is specified (G80, GOl
group G code, reset, etc.)
0 : Canceled after rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to "O".
1 : Canceled before rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to "O".
SIG When gears are changed for rigid tapping, the use of SIND <G032 and
G033> is
0 : Not permitted.
1 : Permitted.
DOV Override during extraction in rigid tapping
0 : Invalidated
1 : Validated (The override value is set in parameter No.5211.)
PCP Rigid tapping
0 : Used as a bigb-speed peck tapping cycle
1 : Not used as a bigb-speed peck tapping cycle
FHD Feed hold and single block in rigid tapping
0 : Invalidated
1 : Validated
SRS To select a spindle used for rigid tapping in multi-spindle control:
0 : The spindle selection signals SWS 1 and SWS2 (bits 0 and 1 of G027)
are used. (These signals are used also for multi-spindle control.)
1 : The rigid tapping spindle selection signals RGTSPl and RGTSP2
(bits 4 and 5 of G061) are used. (These signals are provided expressly
for rigid tapping.)
- 228 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
This parameter can be used only for a serial spindle.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ lt--~--+~~-+-~~-+-1-~-~-:--+1~R_G_S-+-1~:-::~1t--~--+~~-t
[Data type] Bit
REF Feed forward during movement from the initial point to point R in rigid
tapping is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
When this parameter is set, the following function is also enabled:
• When rigid tapping is specified in look-ahead control mode, the
system automatically exits from look-ahead control mode and
executes rigid tapping. After termination of rigid tapping, the system
automatically returns to look-ahead control mode.
-229-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
RGS When bit 0 (MIF) of parameter No. 1403 is set to 1 and rigid tapping is
specified in feed-per-minute mode, the spindle speed becomes:
0 : 1/1000 of the specified speed.
1 : 1/1 of the specified speed.
OVS In rigid tapping, override by the feedrate override signal and invalidation
of override by the override cancel signal is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
Setting this parameter enables override by the feedrate override signal
<G012> to be applied for rigid tapping operation (cutting and extraction)
in rigid tapping.
The spindle speed override is fixed to 100%, but override is also applied to
the spindle speed in synchronization with the feedrate along the tapping
axis by feedrate override.
The override cancel signal OVC <bit 4 of G006> also become available.
NOTE
1 When this parameter is set to override the feedrate, override
by parameters (see parameters Nos. 5211 (T/M) and 5381
(M)) is disabled.
2 Regardless of whether this parameter is set, when feedrate
override is disabled by the override cancel signal OVC <bit
4 of G006>, override by parameters (see parameters Nos.
5211 (T/M) and 5381 (M)) is enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 230-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
1 When switching between the rigid tapping parameters on a
spindle-by-spindle basis in rigid tapping using the second
serial spindle, set this parameter to 1. The following
parameters are supported for each spindle:
First spindle Second spindle
(~tage gear) (2-stage gear)
No.5214 No.5215
No.5221 to No.5224 No.5225, No.5226
No.5231 to No.5234 No.5235, No.5236
No.5241 to No.5244 No.5245, No.5246
No.5261 to No.5264 No.5265, No.5266
No.5271 to No.5274 No.5335, No.5336
No.5280 No.5341
No.5281 to No.5284 No.5242, No.5243
No.5300, No.5301 No.5302, No.5303
No.5310to No.5314 No.5350 to No.5353
No.5321 to No.5324 No.5325, No.5326
NOTE
When you want to perform rigid tapping, do not set this
parameter.
If rigid tapping is performed with this parameter set, a
tapping tool, workpiece, or machine may be damaged.
I 5210 I ~I______R_ig_id_ta_pp_in_g_m_od_e_s_pe_ci_fica_t_io_n_M_co_d_e_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
This parameter sets an M code that specifies the rigid tapping mode.
To set an M code larger than 255, set it to parameter No.5212.
- 231 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 The M code is judged to be 29 (M29) when "O" is set.
2 To use an M code whose number is greater than 255, Specify
the code number with parameter No.5212.
5211 I ~I_____0v_e_rr_id_eva_1u_ed_u_rin_g_ri_gid_ta_P_P_ing_e_x1_ra_ct_io_n_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] 1 % or 10 %
[Valid data range] 0 to 200
The parameter sets the override value during rigid tappiog extraction.
NOTE
The override value is valid when DOV in parameter No.5200
11
#4 is 1".
When OVU (bit 3 of parameter No.5201) is 1, the unit of set data
is 10%. An override of up to 200% can be applied to extraction.
I 5212 I ~I______M_cod_et_ha_t_•P_•_cif_ie_sa_r_ig_id_ta_PP_in_g_m_od_•_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] Integer
[Valid data range] 0 to 65535
This parameter sets the M code that specifies the rigid tapping mode.
The M code that specifies the rigid tapping mode is usually set by
parameter 5210. To use an M code whose number is greater than 255,
specify the code number with parameter 5212.
NOTE
If the setting of this parameter is 0, the M code specifying the
rigid tapping mode is determined by the setting of parameter
5210. Otherwise, it is determined by the setting of parameter
5212. The setting of parameter 5212 must always be within
the above valid range.
~ rl-----~R-eru-r-no-r~cle_a_ra-nce~in_pe_c~k-tap-p~in_g_cy_c~le-----~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter input 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Input in incluse 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
- 232-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
q q
d
q q
'
q
d
'
q
NOTE
When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is
set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5214 is applied to the
second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is
set to 1, the setting of parameter No.5215 is applied to the
second spindle, respectively.
- 233 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
I 5221 11
Number of spindle gear teeth {first-stage gear)
I 5222 11
Number of spindle gear teeth (second-stage gear)
I 5223 11
Number of spindle gear teeth (third-stage gear)
a t----N_u_m_be_r_m_s_eco_n_d_s_pin_d_le_g_ea_rra_e_th_(_~_oo_n_d-<l_ra_ge_g_ea_~_ _ _--<
NOTE
1 These parameters are enabled when the VGR parameter
(bit 1 of parameter No.5200) is set to 1.
2 When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the
same value for all of parameters No.5221 through No.5224.
3 When the DMR function of the position coder signal is used
with a serial spindle, set the VGR parameter (bit 1 of
parameter No.5200) to 0, and set these parameters to 0.
4 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5221 and
No.5222 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5225 and
No.5226 are applied to the second spindle.
- 234-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 5231 11
Number of position coder gear teeth (first-stage gear)
I 5232 11
Number of position coder gear teeth (second-stage gear)
I 5233 11
Number of position coder gear teeth (third-stage gear)
r-:::::1 Number of position coder gear teeth fort ha second spindle (second-stage gear)
LJ ~--------------------~
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 1 to 32767
When an arbitrary gear ratio is used in rigid tapping, each of these
parameters sets the number of teeth of each position coder gear.
NOTE
1 These parameters are enabled when the VGR parameter
(bit 1 of parameter No.5200) is set to 1.
When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the
same value for all of parameters No.5231 through No.5234.
When a spindle motor with a built-in position coder is used,
a position coder with a resolution of 2048 pulses/rev may be
used. In such a case, set the actual number of teeth,
multiplied by 2 (for conversion to 4096 pulses/rev).
2 When the DMR function of the position coder signal is used
with a serial spindle, set the VGR parameter (bit 1 of
parameter No.5200) to 0, and set these parameters to 0.
3 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
spindles
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5231 and
No.5232 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5235 and
No.5236 are applied to the second spindle.
- 235 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
t----M_ax_im_u_m_s_pi_nd_l•_•_P_••_d_in_ri_gi_d_tap_p_in_g_(f_ou_rt_k_tag_e_g_e_ar_)_ _____,
r-::::'l
~
Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping using the second spindle (first-stage gear)
t-----------------------1
EJ I Maximum spinde speed in rigid 12pping using the second spindle (second-§ge gear) I
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] min-I
[Valid data range] Spindle position coder gear ratio
1:1 Oto 7400
1:2 0 to 9999
1:4 0 to 9999
1:8 0 to 9999
Each of these parameters is used to set a maxlln.um spindle speed for each
gear in rigid tapping.
NOTE
1 For the M series, set the same value for both parameter
No.5241 and parameter No.5243 for a one--stage gear
system. For a two-stage gear system, set the value of
parameter No.5241 or No.5242, whichever is greater, in
parameter No.5243. Otherwise, P/S alarm No.200 will be
issued.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5241 and
No.5242 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5245 and
No.5246 are applied to the second spindle.
- 236-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
(first-<!lagegear)
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
(second-<ltagegear)
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
(third-stagegear)
EJ
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
(fourth-stagegear)
EJ
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the second spindle and tap-
ping axis (first-stage gear)
EJ
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the second spindle and tap-
ping axis (second-stage gear)
NOTE
When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
spindles
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5261 and
No.5262 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5265 and
No.5266 are applied to the second spindle.
- 237 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
5271 I lime conslant for the spindle and tapJ>ng axis in extraction operation (firsHtage gew) I
~ ...._"_'m_•_c_on_•_ta_nt-fo_r_th_•_•Pl_·n_d_l•_•n_d_t•_p_pi-ng_ax_i•-in_•_xl_ra_ct_io_n_ope_ra_tio_n
L.::J (second-<ltagegear) _ _ __,
I 5273 I Ilime ccnslant for the s~ndle and tapping axis in extraction operation (ttirtl-<ltage gear) I
Q
LJ5274
,__"_'m_•_c_on_•_ta_nt-fo_r_th_•_•Pl_·n_d_l•_•n_d_t•_P_Pi-ng_ax_i•-in_•_xt_ra_ct_io_n_ope_ra_tio_n
(fourth-stagegear) _ _ __,
NOTE
1 These parameters are enabled when the TDR parameter (bit
2 of parameter No.5201) is set to 1.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5271 and
No.5272 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5335 and
No.5336 are applied to the second spindle.
- 238 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
L..::_J ~P-o-•lt-io_n_co_n_1ro_1_1o_op_g_.,_·n-fo-rt_h•_•_p_in-dl_•_•n_d_tap_pi-ng_ax_i•-in_n_gi-dta_pp_in_g--~
r-;;l _ (common to all gears)
~ ~P-o-•lt-io_n_co_n_tro_1_1oo_p_g_•_in-fo-rt_h_••_p_in-dl_•_•n_d_ta_pp_i_ng_ax_i•-in-ri-gi-dta-pp-in_g--~
l;;l _ (first-..tagegear)
~ ~P-o-•lt-io_n_co_n_tro_1_1oo_p_g_•_in-fo-rt_h_••_p_in-dl_•_•n_d_ta_pp_i_ng_ax_i•-in-ri-gi-dta-pp-in_g--~
L.::J _(second-<ltagegear)
L..::_J ~P-o-•lt-io_n_co_n_tro_1_1oo_p_g_•_in-fo-rt_h_••_p_in-dl_•_•n_d_ta_pp_i_ng_ax_i•-in-ri-gi-dta-pp-in_g--~
l;;l _ (third-<ltagegear)
EJ 2B4
NOTE
l-
_P_o_•lt-io_n_co_n_tro_1_1oo_p_g_•_in-fo-rt_h_••_p_in-dl_•_•n_d_ta_pp_i_ng_ax_i•-in-ri-gi-dta-pp-in_g
(fourth-stagegear) _ __,
NOTE
1 To use a varied loop gain on a gear-by-gear basis, set
parameter No.5280 to 0, and set a loop gain for each gear
in parameters No.5281 through No.5284. The specification
of a loop gain on a gear-by-gear basis is disabled if
parameter No.5280 is set to a value other than 0. In such
a case, the value set in parameter No.5280 is used as a loop
gain that is common to all the gears.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPA parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5280 or the
settings of parameters No.5281 and No.5282 are applied
to the second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
• When the SPA parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5341 through
No.5343 are applied to the second spindle.
- 239-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS B--63610EN/01
5291 I _I___s_pi_nd_1e_1_oo_p_g_ai_n_m_u_lti_Pl_ie_ri_n_th_e_r1g_id_tap_p_in_g_m_oc1_e_(fo_r_ge_a_r_1J_ _~
5292 I ._I___s_pi_nd_le_l_oo_p_g_a_in_m_u_lti_pl_ie_ri_n_th_e_rig_id_ta_PP'_·n_g_m_o_d_e_(fo_r_gea_r_2J_ ___.
I 5293 I _l___s_pi_nd_le_l_oo_p_g_a_in_m_u_lti_pl_ie_ri_n_th_e_rig_id_ta_PP'_·n_g_m_o_d_e_~o_r_gea_r_3l_ _~
EJ
[Data type] Word type
Spindle loop gain multioplier in the rigid tapping mode (for gear4)
NOTE
These parameters are used for analog spindles.
Flg.4.25 (b) Connection among the splndle motor, splndle, and position coder
-240-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
5300 I ~I_____li_ap_p_in_g_ax_is_i_ll-jlO_s_iu_·o_nw_id_t_h_in_rig_id_tap_p_in_g_ _ _ _~
5301 I ~I______s_pi_nd_l•_in;i_os_iti_on_wi_·d_th_i_nr_ig_id_ta_p_p;_ng_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 32767
These parameters are used to set tapping axis and spindle in-position
widths in rigid tapping.
NOTE
1 If an excessively large value is specified, the threading
precision will deteriorate.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
(T series)
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameter No.5300 and
No.5301 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5302 and
No.5303 are applied to the second spindle.
1::-1
~
Tapping axis in-position width in rigid tapping using the second spindle
>-------------------------!
1::-1
~
Spindle in-position width in rigid tapping using the second spindle
>-------------------------!
NOTE
These parameters are enabled when the SPR parameter
(bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
5308 I ~l____1_n-pos
__it_io_nw_i_~_h_m_po_i_nt_R_in_r_ig_id_ta_p_pin_g_(ta_PP_in_g_ax_i•_l_ _ _~
- 241
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
531 O II Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping
NOTE
1 When a high-resolution detector is used, the unit must be
multiplied by 10.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5310 (or No.5314)
is applied to the second spindle, as well as to the first
spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameter No.5350 is applied
to the second spindle, respectively.
5311 II Limit value of spindle positioning deviation during movement in rigid tapping.
-242-
B--63610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(Calculation example)
S= 3600
Spindle
Motor
G = 3000
L= 360 degrees (One spindle rotation per spindle motor rotation)
Position a= La/4096
......_.........,..____. Spindle coder =720 degrees/4096
P.C =0.17578 degrees
La = 720 degrees
(One position coder rotation requires two spindle rotations
(= 360 degrees x 2)).
4096 = Detection pulse per position coder rotation
. 3600x360x100x1.5
Settmg va 1ue = 60 x 3000 x 0 .17578
= 6144
1 : 1 :2
Fig.4.25 (c) Connection among spindle motor, spindle and position coder
NOTE
1 The detection unit is a= La/2048 when the position coder
built-4n spindle motor uses a position coder of 512 pulses
per revolution.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
spindles
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to O, the setting of parameter No.5311 is applied to
the second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameter No.5351 is applied
to the second spindle, respectively.
I 5312 I I Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping I
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 1 to 32767
This parameter is used to set a positional deviation limit imposed while
the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping.
NOTE
When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to O, the setting of parameter No.5312 is applied to
the second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameter No.5352 is applied
to the second spindle, respectively.
- 243 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
I 5313 II Positional deviation limit imposed while the spindle is stopped in rigid tapping
NOTE
When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5313 is applied to
the second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameter No.5353 is applied
to the second spindle, respectively.
I 5314 Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping
NOTE
1 When parameter No.5314 is set to 0, the setting of
parameter No.5310 is used. When parameter No.5314 is
set to a value other than 0, parameter No.5310 is disabled;
in this case, the setting of parameter No.5314 is used.
2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5314 (or No.5310)
is applied to the second spindle, as well as to the first
spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameter No.5350 is applied
to the second spindle, respectively.
-244-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
a 5321
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (first-stage gear)
f-------~-----------------1
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping
~ t------S_p_in_dl_eba_ckl_as_h_in_rig_id_tap_p_in_g_(se_co_nd-5_m_g_e_ge_a_r)_ _ ___,
1::-1
~
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (thinkmge gear)
t--------------------------1
l':':'l
LJ Spindle backlash in rigid tapping (fourth-stage gear)
f-------------------------1
a 5325
1::1
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle (first-stage gear)
t----~---------------------1
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle
Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle (second-stage gear)
~ ~---------------------~
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] Detection unit
[Valid data range] 0 to 127
Each of these parameters is used to set a spindle backlash.
NOTE
When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5321 and
No.5322 are applied to the second spindle, as well as to
the first spindle.
• When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5325 and
No.5326 are applied to the second spindle.
- 245 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
B
Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in second spindle extraction
operation (first-stage gear)
B
Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in second spindle extraction
operation (second-stage gear)
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when both the TDR parameter
(bit 2 of parameter No.5201) and the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) are set to 1.
B
Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
the second spindle (common to all the gears)
B
Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
the second spindle (first-stage gear)
B
Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
the second spindle (second-stage gear)
NOTE
After these parameters have been set, the power must be
turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
NOTE
1 To use a varied loop gain on a gear-by-gear basis, set
parameter No.5341 to 0, and set a loop gain for each gear
in parameters No.5342 and No.5343.
2 This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
-246-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ 350
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
EJ 351
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
EJ 352
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
- 247 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ353
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
~ 1-l------0v-.-rr-ide_v_a_lu_e_ro_rr_ig-id_m_pp_i-ng-ret-ur_n_ _ _ _ ___,
NOTE
This parameter is valid when bit 4 (DOV) of parameter No.
5200 is set to 1. If bit 3 (OVU) of parameter No. 5201 is set
to 1, 10% is set as the units of data. Thus, an override of
up to 2000% can be applied during extraction.
~ 1-1------A-m-ou_n_tm_ret_u_rn_ro_r_rig-id-t-ap_p_in-g-~-tu_m_ _ _ _ ___,
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] Input increments
[Valid data range] 0 to 99999999
During rigid tapping return for the machlning return and restart function,
the tool can be pulled out, along the tapping axis, going beyond the stored
rigid tapping start position by the amount specified with this parameter.
- 248 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.26
PARAMETERS OF
SCALING/ #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
COORDINATE ~ l>--S-C-R--+-X-S-C-+----+--R-C-W--+---+----+----+--R-IN---1
ROTATION
[Data type] Bit
RIN Coordinate rotation angle command (R)
0 : Specified by an absolute method
1 : Specified by G90 or G91
RCW When a workpiece or local coordinate system command is issued in
coordinate system rotation mode:
0 : No alarm is issued.
1 : An alarm (P/S alarm No. 5302) is issued.
XSC Axis scaling and programmable mirror image
0 : Invalidated (The scaling magnification is specified by P.)
1 : Validated
SCR Scaling magnification unit
0 : 0.00001 times (1/100,000)
1 : 0.001 times
r::-i ~_-A-ng_u_l•-•d-is_p_l•_ce_m_•_nt_u•_•_d_w_h•_"_"_o
LJ din ate system rotation co_o•~
_•n_g_ui_ar_d_isp-la_ce_m_•_n_ti_•_•pe-cif-ie_d_fo_r
~
~
t----..,.,----,,--,---,..-,-----,,----..,,,---,---.,.---..,,,--,------1
Magnification used when scaling magnification is not specified
-249-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
Parameter No.5421 becomes valid when scaling for every
axis is valid. (XSC, #6 of parameter No.5400 is "1 ".)
~ r1~~~~~---,S~ca~li~ng_m_a_gn~if~ica-ti~on~f~or_ev_e-~-~~is~~~~~~~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data] 0.001 or 0.00001 times (Selected using SCR, #7 of parameter No.5400)
[Valid data range] -999999 to -1, 1 to 999999
This parameter sets the scaling magnification for every axis.
- 250-
B--63610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.27
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
UNI-DIRECTIONAL
POSITIONING
[Data type] Bit
MDL Specifies whether the G code for single direction positioning (G60) is
included in one-shot G codes (00 group) or modal G codes (01 group)
0: One-shot G codes (00 group)
1: Modal G codes (01 group)
PDI When the tool is stopped before or after a specified end point with the
unidirectional positioning function:
0 : No in-position check is performed.
1 : An in-position check is performed.
Overrun
distance
--
-- -
~
Start
point -
--
-
r. Start
point
End point Stop after overrun
~
L::J Positionilll direction and overrun dislance in uni-<:lireclional positiorilll for each axis
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-8 IS-C Unit
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
+
Positioning direction (plus}
- 251-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.28
PARAMETERS OF
NORMAL DIRECTION
CONTROL
~
L:J >------------------------!
Number of the axis for controlling the normal direction
~
~
f------~~~~-~-~~--~~------l
Rotationfeedrate of normal direction control axis
B >---L-im_lt_v-al-ue-t-ha-1-ig-no-re-s-th-e-rot-a-ti-on-i-nse-rt-io_n_o_fn_o_nn_a_Id-irecti-·-on_c_o_nt-ro-1ax-is___,
NOTE
1 No rotation block is inserted when 360 or more degrees are
set.
2 If 180 or more degrees are set, a rotation block is inserted
only when the circular interpolation is 180 or more degrees.
- 252-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
[Data type] 2-word
Limit value of movement that is executed at the normal direction angle of a pre-
ceding block
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A 15-B I~ Unit
Millimeter input O.Q1 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch input 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
N2
Tool center path For straight line
Block N2 is machined with the tool being normal
~I to block N1 when the movement of N2 in the
'/
N1 I figure on the left does not exceed the set value.
I
Movement
Programmed path
N1
····.• N2 Tool center path For arc
-......,.........__··--...,;
..··· .
Arc N2 is machined with the tool being normal
to block N1 when the arc diameter of N2 in the
/ ': ________j\J3____ _ figure on the left does not exceed the setting
value. A normal direction axis is not controlled
to move in the normal direction according to
the arc movement.
Diameter
- 253 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
Workpiece
® "~-·- · ·- · · · · · · · · -
(6)
'·,·..., ...........
-·- -·- ---·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·----->-·-------·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-··
- 254-
B-ll3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When this parameter is set to 1, no interference check is
made in cutter compensation C.
EJ ~u-·m-it-im_pos_ed_on_t_h•_i_n•_•_rti-on_o_1_a•_in_g_l•_b_lock-fo_r_ro_ta_ti-on_a_bo_u_t _h_•_no_rm_a_1_~
485
[Unitofdatal,...,....------.,.--=--,---.,.--=-=---..--=--=---..-.,.,...,,.....---.
Increment system IS-A IS-B Is-<: Units
Rotation axis O.Q1 0.001 0.0001 deg
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the SDC parameter (bit 0
of parameter No.5484) is set to 1. If a value equal to or
greater than 180 degrees is specified, a C-axis movement
is inserted only when circular interpolation involving a C-axis
rotation of 180 degrees or more is performed.
- 255 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.29
PARAMETERS OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
INDEXING INDEX
TABLE
~ l>---ID-X--+~S-IM~+-~~>--G-9-0--+~IN-C~+--AB-S~>--R-E-L--+~D-D-P_,
[Data type] Bit type
DDP Selection of decimal-point input method of index table indexing axis
0 : Conventional method (Example IS-B: Bl; = 0.001 deg)
1 : Pocket calculator method (Example IS-B: B 1; = 1.000 deg)
REL Relative position display of index table indexing axis
0 : Not rounded by 360 degrees
1 : Rounded by 360 degrees
ABS Displaying absolute coordinate value of index table indexing axis
0 : Not rounded by 360 degrees
The index table indexing axis rotates 720 degrees (two rotations)
when G90 B720.0; is specified from the 0--degree position. It rotates
in reverse direction 720 degrees (two rotations) when G90 BO.; is
specified. The absolute coordinate value then becomes 0 degree.
1 : Rounded by 360 degrees
The index table indexing axis is positioned in 40 degrees when G90
B400.0; is specified from the 0--degree position. The index table
indexing axis does not rotate by two or more turns when this
parameter is set to I. It also does not move when G90 B720.0; is
specified from the 0--degree position.
INC Rotation in the G90 mode when negative-direction rotation command M
code (parameter No.5511) is not set
0 : Not set to the shorter way around the circumference
1 : Set to the shorter way around the circumference (Set ABS, #2 of
parameter No.5500, to I.)
G90 Index table indexing command
0 : Judged to be an absolute/increment command according to the
G90/G91 mode
1 : Judged to be an absolute command
SIM When the same block includes a command for an index table indexing
axis and a command for another controlled axis:
0 : A PIS alarm (No.136) is issued.
1 : The commands are executed. (In a block other than GOO, G28, and
G30, however, a P/S alarm (No.136) is issued.)
IDX Index table indexing sequence
0: TypeA
l:TypeB
~ ~1~~~~~N-e_g_m-we-<1~-irect~io-n-~-ra-tio_n_co_m_m_a_n_d_M_cod~e~~~~----1
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
0 : Not use an M code that sets the index table rotation to the negative
direction. The rotation direction is specified using a command and
parameter (INC, #3 of parameter No.5500).
- 256-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1 to 255:
Sets an M code that sets the index table rotation to the negative
direction. The rotation is set to the negative direction only when an M
code set here is specified in the same block as an index table indexing
command. If the M code is not specified in the same block, the
rotation is always set to the positive direction.
NOTE
Set ABS, #2 of parameter No.5500, to 1.
~ r1~~~~~~~Un_lt_m~i-nd-e-xra_b_le-i-nd-e-xi-ng_a_n-gl-e~~~~~~_,
[Data type] 2-word
[Unitofdata]~----~-~-~-~~~-~~~---~
Input Increment IS-A IS-B 19-C Unit
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
NOTE
If zero is specified as the setting value, any command can
be specified irrespective of the unit of angle.
- 257 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.30
PARAMETERS OF
CUSTOM MACROS #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
SBV SBM HGO MGO G67
SBV SBM HGO V15 MGO G67
The tables below indicate the system variables for tool offset numbers 1 to
999. The values for tool offset numbers 1 to 200 can be read from or
assigned to the system variables in parentheses.
--------
Geomentry offset value
--------
H--Code Geom entry
offset value
Wear offset value
System parameter number
V15=0
#11001 to #11999
(#2201 to #2400)
#10001 to #10999
(#2001 to #2200)
V15= 1
#10001 to #10999
(#2001 to #2200)
#11001 to #11999
(#2201 to #2400)
D-Code Geom entry #13001 to #13999 #12001 to #12999
offset value
Wear offset value #12001 to #12999 #13001 to #13999
- 258 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
This bit is invalid when bit 0 (NOP) of parameter No. 6000 is
set to 1. (M series)
#0
I soo1 I l~c_L_v~_c_c_v~_rc_s_~c_R_o~_P_v_s~--~-P_R_T~--~
[Data type] Bit
PRT Reading zero when data is output using a DPRINT command
0 : Outputs a space
1 : Outputs no data
PVS Custom macro common variables:
0 : Nos. 500 to 599 are output.
1 : Nos. 100 to 199 and Nos. 500 to 599 are output.
CRO ISO code in BPRWT or DPRNT commond
0 : Outputs only LF after data is output
1 : Outputs LF and CR after data is output
TCS Subprogram
0 : Not called using a T code
1 : Called using a T code
CCV Custom macro's common variables Nos. 100 through 149 (to 199)
0: Cleared to "vacant" by reset
1: Not cleared by reset
CLV Custom macro's local variables Nos. 1 through 33
0: Cleared to "vacant" by reset
1: Not cleared by reset
- 259-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#0
sooa I l>--M_u_s--+~M_c_v-+-~M_SB~>--M-P_R--+~T-S_E-+-~M-IN~>--M_s_K--+~~~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
#7 #2 #1 #0
~ 1>--~--+~~-+-~D-15~>--~--+~~-+-~VH_D~>--~-:-~--+~~-:-~_,
[Data type] Bit
NAT Specification of the results of custom macro functions ATAN
0 : The result of ATAN is 0 to 360.0.
1 : The result of ATAN is -180 to 0 to 180.0.
MFZ If the angle of a custom macro operation command SIN, COS, or TAN is
1.0 X 10**-8 orbeloworiftheresultofoperationisnotaccurately 0, the
operation result is:
0: Handled as underflow.
1: Normalized to 0.
-260-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
When the 015 parameter is set to 1, system variables #2500
through #2806, for workpiece reference point offset values,
cannot be used. Instead, use system variables #5201
through #5324.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is continued.
- 261-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
6010 '7 •5 •5 •4 •3 ·2 ·1 ·o
6011 .7 .s .5 .4 .3 .2 .1 .o
6012 #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
6013 [7 [6 [5 [4 [3 [2 [1 [O
6014 ]7 ]6 ]5 ]4 ]3 ]2 ]1 ]O
I 6030 I ~I______M_co_d_e_th_a_tc_a_lls_th_e_p_rog_ra_m_e_nt_ered_i_nf_ile_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0, and 1 to 255
This parameter sets an M code that calls the program entered in a file.
NOTE
The M code is judged to be M198 when zero is specified as
the setting value.
6033 I ~I_____M_cod_e_th_a_tv_a_lid_a_tes_ac_u_sto_m_m_ac_ro_i_nt_er_ru_p_t----~
6034 I ~I_____M_co_d_e_th_at_in_v_al_ida_tes_a_c_ust_o_m_m_ac_ro_in_te_rr_up_t_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 255
These parameters set the custom macro interrupt valid/invalid M codes.
NOTE
These parameters can be used when MPR, #4 of parameter
No.6003, is 1. M96 is used as a valid M code and M97 is
used as an invalid M code when MPR is 0, irrespective of the
state of this parameter.
-262-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6050 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 901 O
6051 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9011
6052 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9012
6053 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9013
6054 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9014
6055 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9015
6056 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9016
6057 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9017
6058 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9018
6059 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9019
NOTE
Setting value 0 is invalid. No custom macro can be called by
GOO.
NOTE
Setting value 0 is invalid. No subprogram can be called by
MOO.
- 263 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
6080 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9020
6081 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9021
6082 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9022
6083 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9023
6084 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9024
6085 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9025
6086 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9026
6087 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9027
6088 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9028
6089 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9029
NOTE
Setting value 0 is invalid. No custom macro can be called by
MOO.
6090 I ~I___A_s_c_11_cod_e_1h_a_1c_a_11s_1_he_s_u_bp_rog_ra_m_o_f_p_rog_ra_m_n_um_be_r_so_04_ _ _~
6091 I I. .___A_s_c_11_cod_e_1h_a_1c_a_11s_1_he_s_u_bp_rog_ra_m_o_f_p_rog_ra_m_n_um_be_r_so_os_ _ __,
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
Set 0 when no subprogram is called
-264-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.31
PARAMETERS OF
6095 Number of programs used for simple macro calls
SIMPLE MACROS
[Data type] Byte
[Unit of data] Number of programs
[Valid data range] 0 to 16
This parameter specifies the number of programs used for simple macro
calls. When 3 is set, for example, three programs can be called. In this
case, the three signals, MCSTl, MCST2, and MCST3, among MCSTl
through MCSTl 6 are enabled as the macro call activation signals for
calling the programs. If this parameter is set to 0, this function is disabled.
I 6096 I ~l__N_u_m_be_r_m_th_a_fi_~_tp_rog_ra_m_o_fp_r_og_ra_m_s_u_sad_ro_r_sim_pla_m_a_c_ro_ca_l_ls_~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Number
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
Register the 0 number of the first program used for simple macro calls.
When 9000 is set, for example, the relationship between the macro call
activation signals (MCSTx) and program numbers activated by the
signals is as follows:
MCSTI signal : Activates 09000
(when the value of parameter No. 6095 is 1 or greater).
MCST2 signal: Activates 09001
(when the value of parameter No. 6095 is 2 or greater).
MCST3 signal : Activates 09002
(when the value of parameter No. 6095 is 3 or greater).
6097 I ~I_____sta_rtad_d_ra_ss_o_fs_ig_n_al_s_us_ad_f_o_rs_im_p_la_m_ac_ro_ca_ll_s---~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Number
[Valid data range] 0 to 65535
This parameter specifies the start address of signals used for simple macro
calls. When 500 is set, for example, R500 through R506 are used as
signals for simple macro calls. If a nonexistent number is set, this
function is disabled.
- 265 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.32
PARAMETERS OF 6101 First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 1
PATTERN DATA
6102 First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 2
INPUT
6103 First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 3
-266-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.33
PARAMETERS OF
POSITIONING
BY OPTIMUM
ACCELERATION NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ >--~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-I
L..:::.J Distance 01 to the first stage of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis
B I Distance D21o 1he second srage of positioring by optimum acceler-. for each axis I
~ f-=-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~,--J
L..:::.J Distance 03 to the third stage of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis
- 267 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Set the positioning distances used when the function for 4-stage
switching of the rapid traverse rate, time constant, and loop gain based on
positioning distance is used.
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Units
Linear axis (inch input) 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
These parameters set the positioning distances used when the function for
adjusting the rapid traverse rate, time constant, and loop gain to one of
seven levels according to the positioning distance is used. (The settings
are common to all axes.)
- 268 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
B
[Data type] 2-word axis
Seventh-stage rapid traverse rate
-269-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
Seventh-stage rapid traverse time constant
[Unit of data] ms
[Valid data range] 8 to 4000
Specify rapid traverse time constants for each axis.
B
[Data type] Word axis
Seventh-stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
- 270-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
- 271-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.34
PARAMETERS OF
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
SKIP FUNCTION SKF SRE SLS HSS MIT SKO GSK
SKF SRE HSS SKO
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
SPE IGX TSA TSE SEB SEA
SPE CSE IGX TSA TSE SEB SEA
-272-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
There are two types of compensation: Types A and B. Wrth
the skip function, the current posttion is stored in the CNC
according to the skip signal. However, the current position
stored in the CNC contains servo delay. The machine position
is therefore deviated by the servo delay. The deviation can be
obtained from the position deviation of the servo and the error
generated due to feedrate acceleration/deceleration
performed by the CNC. If the deviation can be compensated,
tt is not necessary to include the servo delay in measurement
errors. The deviation can be compensated with the following
two types by the parameter as follows:
(1) Type A: The deviation is the value calculated from
the cutting time constant and servo time
constant (loop gain).
(2) Type B: The deviation is the error due to
acceleration/deceleration and the position
deviation when the skip signal goes on.
TSE When the torque limit skip function (G31 P99/98) is used, the skip
position held in a system variable is:
0 : Position that is offset considering the delay (positional deviation)
incurred by the servo system.
1 : Position that does not reflect the delay incurred by the servo system.
NOTE
The torque limit skip function stores the current position in the
CNC when the torque limn arrival signal is turned on. However,
the current position in the CNC includes a servo system delay,
so that the position is shifted from the machine position by an
amount corresponding to the servo system delay. The value
of this shift can be determined from the servo system positional
deviation. When TSE is set to 0, a skip position is determined
by subtracting the positional deviation from the current
position. When TSE is set to 1, the current position (including
the servo system delay) is used as the skip posttion, wtthout
considering any shift or position deviation.
TSA When the torque limit skip function (G31 P99/98) is used, torque limit
arrival monitoring is performed for:
0: All axes.
1 : Only those axes that are specified in the block containing the G31
command.
IGX When the higb-speed skip function is used, SKIP (bit 7 ofX004), SKIPP
(bit 6 of G006), and +MITl to -MIT2 (bits 2 to 5 of X004) are:
0 : Enabled as skip signals.
1 : Disabled as skip signals.
- 273 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 SKIPP (bit 6 of G006) and +MIT1 to-MIT2 (btts 2 to 5 of X004)
are enabled only when bit 0 (GSK) of parameter No.6200 is set
to 1 and btt 3 (MIT) of parameter No.6200 is setto 1. Note also
that these signals are enabled only for the T series.
2 The skip signals for the multistage skip function (T series :
SKIP, SKIP2 to SKIPS) can also be disabled.
CSE For continuos high-speed skip command G31 P90, high-speed skip
signals are :
0 : Effective at either a rising or falling edge (depending on the setting of
bit 6 (SRE) of parameter 6200)
1 : Effective for both the rising and falling edges
SPE For the skip function (G31), the skip signal (bit 7 of X004) is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
B
[Data type] Bit
058 057 056 DS5 054 053 052 051
lSl Specify high-speed skip signal (HDIO) is enabled when the G31 skip
command is issued.
lSl - HDIO
lSl to 1S8, 2Sl to 2S8, 3Sl to 3S8, 4Sl to 4S8, DSl to DS8
Specify which skip signal is enabled when the skip command (G31, or
G31Pl to G31P4) and the dwell command (G04, G04Ql to G04Q4) are
issued with the multi-step skip function.
The following table shows the correspondence between the bits, input
signals, and commands.
The setting of the bits have the following meaning :
0 : The skip signal corresponding to the bit is disabled.
1 : The skip signal corresponding to the bit is enabled.
- 274-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Input G31
signal
HDIO 1S1
~
G31
G31P2 G31P2 G31P4
G31P1 G04
I G04Q2 G04Q2 G04Q4
G04Q1
sg a
SKIP/HDIO 1S1 2S1 3S1 4S1 DS1
SKIP2 1S2 2S2 3S2 4S2 DS2
SKIP3 1S3 2S3 3S3 483 DS3
SKIP4 184 2S4 3S4 484 084
SKIPS 1S5 2S5 3S5 485 DSS
SKIPS 1S6 2S6 3S6 4S6 DS6
SKIP7 1S7 2S7 3S7 4S7 DS7
SKIPS 1S8 2S8 3S8 488 DS8
NOTE
HDIO is high-speed skip signals.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
6210 11~-~--~-~--~-~--~R_OS_~-~
[Data type] Bit
ROS When the skip position goes beyond the roll--0ver range, the values of
system variables #5061 througb #5068 indicating the skip signal position:
0 : Are not rolled over.
1 : Are rolled over similar to the absolute coordinates.
n #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ ~
I 5215 I ~I--~-~--~-~--~-~--~-cs_T~
[Data type] Bit axis
CST For the Cs contour controlled axis, the torque limit skip function is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
Torque limit skip operation is performed for the Cs counter controlled
axis by using the serial spindle torque limit command signal
TLMH<G070, G074, G204, G266> and the load detection signal
LDT1<F045, F049, Fl96, F266>.
- 275 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When this parameter is set to perform torque limit skip
operation for a Cs counter controlled axis, note the following:
1 For the Cs contour controlled axis (spindle) that uses the
torque limit skip function, set bit 4 of serial spindle parameter
No. 4009 to 1 so that load detection signals are output even
during acceleration/deceleration.
2 If the load detection state (LDT1 = 1) is set when the torque
limit command is specified (TLMH 1 = 1) in the Cs mode, no
excessive error check at stop is performed for the axis.
3 If the load detection state (LDT1 = 1) is set in the Cs mode,
no in-position check is made for the axis.
- 276-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.35
PARAMETERS OF
AUTOMATIC TOOL
COMPENSATION
(T SERIES) AND
AUTOMATIC TOOL
LENGTH
COMPENSATION #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
B
Faedrateduring measurement of automatic tool compensation
6241 >------------------------1
Feed rate during measurement of automatic tool length compensation
B 6251
r-:::-1
y value on X axis during automatic tool compensation
>------------------------1
yvalue during automatic tool length automatic compensation
NOTE
Set a radius value irrespective of whether the diameter
programming or the radius programming is specified.
- 277 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
[Data type] 2-word
evalue on Z axis during automatic tool compensation
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
NOTE
Set a radius value irrespective of whether the diameter
programming or the radius programming is specified.
- 278 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.36
PARAMETERS OF
EXTERNAL DATA #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
INPUT/OUTPUT a300 I l~E_E_x~--~--~E_s_R~_Es_c~--~--~-~
[Data type] Bit
ESC When a reset is input between input of the external data input read signal
ESTB and execution of a search, the external program number search
function:
0 : Performs a search.
1 : Does not perform a search.
ESR External program number search
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
EEX PMC EXIN function
0 : Conventional specifications
1 : Extended specifications
If you want to handle data unavailable with the PMC/EXIN command
according to the conventional specifications, set this bit to 1.
For details of EXIN and how to change ladder software, refer to the PMC
specifications and other manuals.
- 279-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.37 #7 #1
#6 #5 #3
PARAMETERS OF 1::1 I HMB HM5 HFW HRP
RETRACING BY THE L'.'._J !----+---+---+---+---+---+---+----;
MANUAL HANDLE ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
These parameters set the number of M code groups and the number of M
codes in each group.
(See explanations of parameters Nos. 6411 to 6490.)
When 16 groups of five are used, the meanings of parameters are changed
as follows:
Group A No.6411(1) to No.6415(5)
GroupB No.6416(1) to No.6420(5)
LJ
Q 6410
1--T_ra_v_el-di-•ta_n_c_e
retrace function _pe_r_pu-ls_e_ge_n_e_ra_te_d
by the manual handlef_ro_m_t_he_m_a_n_ua_Ip-u-lse-ge_n_era_t_o_rfo-r-th_e_---1
- 280-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
M code (1) in group A for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group A for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group A for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group A for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group B for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group B for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group B for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group B for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group C for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group C for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group C for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group C for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 281 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
M code (1) in group D for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group D for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group D for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group D for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group E for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group E for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group E for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group E for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group F for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group F for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group F for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group F for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 282-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
M code (1) in group G for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group G for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group G for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group G for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group H for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group H for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group H for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group H for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group I for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group I for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group I for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group I for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 283 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
M code {1) in group J for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group J for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group J for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group J for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group K for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group K for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group K for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group K for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group L for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group L for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group L for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group L for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 284-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
M code (1) in group M for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group M for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group M for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group M for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group N for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group N for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group N for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group N for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group 0 for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group 0 for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group 0 for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group 0 for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 285 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
EJ
M code (1) in group P for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group P for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group P for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group P for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group Q for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group Q for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group Q for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group Q for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group R for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group R for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group R for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group R for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 286-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
M code (1) in group S for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group S for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group S for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group S for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (1) in group T for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (2) in group T for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (3) in group T for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
EJ
M code (4) in group T for backward movement by the manual handle retrace
function
- 287 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
The names of the above parameters Nos. 6411 to 6490
indicate those when 20 groups of four M codes are used for
convenience of explanation.
The actual numbers of groups and of M codes in each group
are determined according to the settings of bits 3 (HMS) and
2 (HM5) of parameter No. 6400. Also see the explanation
of those parameters when setting the above parameters.
- 288 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.38
PARAMETERS OF
GRAPHIC DISPLAY
4.38.1
Parameters of Graphic
Display/Dynamic
BI
ssoo
#
7
Ni:M #5 #4 o~A
#2 #1 #0
- - - - 1 - - - + - -P-- - + - - + - - - + - - - - - 1 - - - + - - - - - <
t-·
0 0
Graphic Display ~-~-~-~-~-~--~-~-~
[Data type] Bit
DPA Current position display on the graphic display screen
0 : Displays the actual position to ensure tool nose radius compensation
1 : Displays the programmed position
DPO Current position on the solid drawing (machining profile drawing) or tool
path drawing screen
0 : Not appear
1: Appears
NZM 0 : The screen image is not enlarged by specifying the centerof the screen
and magnification. (Screen image enlargement by a conventional
method is enabled.)
1 : The screen image is enlarged by specifying the center of the screen
and magnification. (Screen image enlargement by the conventional
method is disabled.)
- 289-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~ r1~~~~~~~~D_ra_w_in_g_co_o_ro_i_na_te_s_y_m_em~~~~~~~~-;
x z
x
Set value"' 4 Set value"' 5 Set value"' 6 Set value"' 7
x
z x z
x z x
- 290-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.38.2
Parameters of Graphic 6561 Standard color data for graphic color number 1
Color ::====:
6562 Standard color data for graphic color number 2
[Unit of data] rr gg bb: 6--digit number (rr: Red gg: Green bb: Blue)
When a number of less than six digits is set, the system assumes that 0 has
been specified for the unspecified higher digit(s).
- 291-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
[Valid data range] Data of each color: 00 to 15 (same value as the tone level data on the color
setting screen)
When a value of more than 15 is set, the system assumes that 15 has been
specified.
Example: Set 10203 in this parameter when the color tone levels are as
follows:
Red: 1 Green: 2 Blue: 3
NOTE
To set the color of the VGA display, use the color setting
screen. Note that the color changes when the settings of
parameters No.6561 through No.6595 are modified.
- 292-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.39
PARAMETERS OF
DISPLAYING
OPERATION TIME
AND NUMBER OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
PARTS 6700 I l~-~--~--~-~--~--~-~-PC_M~
[Data type] Bit
PCM M code that counts the total number of machined parts and the number of
machined parts
0 : M02, or M30, or an M code specified by parameter No.6710
1 : Only M code specified by parameter No.6710
~
L.:..:J .___M_cod_•_th_•_t
chined partsco_u_n_ts-th_•_to_ta_I"_"m_be_rof-m-ac-hi-ne_d_p•_rts_•n_d_th_•_""_m_be_•_o_fm_•_----'
NOTE
Set value 0 is invalid (the number of parts is not counted for
MOO). Data 98 and 99 cannot be set.
NOTE
The number of parts is not counted for M02, M03, when bit
O (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.
- 293 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
The number of parts is not counted for M02, M03, when bit
O (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.
6713 I ~I________N_um_b_e_rof_req_u_ir_ed_p_a_rts_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] One piece
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
This parameter sets the number of required machined parts.
Required parts finish signal PRTSF is output to PMC when the number of
machined parts reaches the number of required parts. The number of parts
is regarded as infinity when the number of required parts is zero. The
PRTSF signal is then not output.
I 6750 I l. . _______1m_e_g_ra_~_dv_a_1u_e_of_p_ow_e_r-o_n_pe_ri_od_ _ _ _ _ _~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] One min
[Valid data range] 0 to 99999999
This parameter displays the integrated value of power--0n period.
- 294-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 6754 1nt_eg_r_a1_ed_v_a1_ue_o_f_cu_tt_in_g_tim_e_11
I .__l_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___,
~ .___1n_t•_g_ra_ted_va_1u_•_o_fg_•_n•_ra_~_urpo_•_•_in_te_gr-a1-in_g_m_et_•r_d_riv_•_•i-gn_•_l(-TM-RO_N_>
L.::J ON time I _ _,
- 295 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~ -~ln-1e_g_ra_ted_va_1u_•_o_fg_•_n•_ra_~_urpo_•_•_in_te_gr-at-in_g_m_et_•r_d_riv_•_•i-gn_a_l(-TM-RO_N_)-~
L.:.:J ON time II
I 6757 I ~I___o_pe_ra_11_on_11_m_e_(int_e_g_ra_1e_d_va_1u_e_of_o_n_e_au_10_m_a_tic_o_pe_ra_t_io_n_tim_e_)_1_~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] One ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 60000
I 6758 I ~--O_P_•_ra_Ho_n_ti_m_e(_in_teg_ra_1e_d_va_1u_e_o1_o_ne_a_u_1o_m_au_·c_o_pe_ra_11_on_1_1m_•_l_11_~
Setting entry is acceptable.
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] One min
[Valid data range] 0 to 99999999
This parameter displays the one automatic operation drive time (neither
stop nor hold state included). The actual time accumulated during
operating is the sum of this parameter No. 6757 and parameter No. 6758.
The operation time is automatically preset to 0 during the power-on
sequence and the cycle start from the reset state.
- 296-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.40
PARAMETERS OF #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
TOOL LIFE
MANAGEMENT B
[Data type] Bit
MST IGI
SNG
SNG
GRS
GRS
SIG
SIG
LTM
LTM
GS2
GS2
GS1
GS1
GSl, GS2 lbis parameter sets the combination of the number of tool life groups
which can be entered, and the number of tools which can be entered per
group as shown in the table below.
Mseries Tseries
GS2 GS1
Group count Tool count Group count Tool count
0 0 1to16 1 to 16 1to16 1 to 16
1to64 1to32
0 1 1to32 1to8 1to32 1to8
1to128 1 to 16
1 0 1to64 1to4 1to64 1to4
1 to 256 1to8
1 1 1to128 1to2 1to16 1 to 16
1 to 512 1to4
The values on the lower row in the table apply when for the M series, the
512-tool-life--management-group option is provided.
LTM Tool life
0 : Specified by the number of times
1 : Specified by time
SIG Group number is
0 : Not input using the tool group signal during tool skip (The current
group is specified.)
1 : Input using the tool group signal during tool skip
GRS Tool exchange reset signal
0 : Clears only the execution data of a specified group
1 : Clears the execution data of all entered groups
SNG Input of the tool skip signal when a tool that is not considered tool life
management is selected.
0 : Skips the tool of the group used last or of the specified group (using
SIG, #3 of parameter No.6800).
1 : Ignores a tool skip signal
IGI Tool back number
0 : Not ignored
1: Ignored
M6T T code in the same block as M06
0 : Judged as a back number
1 : Judged as a next tool group command
- 297 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #0
~ l>--M-6-E--+~:-:-~--+-~:-::~>--~--+~E-M-D--+-~LFV~-+--T-S_M--+~~-1
[Data type] Bit
TSM When a tool takes several tool numbers, life is counted in tool life
management:
0 : For each of the same tool numbers.
1 : For each tool.
LFV Specifies whether life count override is enabled or disabled when the
extended tool life management function is used.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
EMD An asterisk (*) indicating that a tool has been expired is displayed,
0 : When the next tool is selected
1 : When the tool life is expired
ElS When the life of a tool is measured in time-based units:
0 : The life is counted every four seconds.
1 : The life is counted every second. (The maximum life is 1075
(minutes).)
NOTE
This parameter is valid when bit 2 (LTM) of parameter
No.6800 is setto 1.
EXT Specifies whether the extended tool life management function is used.
0: Not used
1: Used
EXG Tool life management data registration by GlO (T series) is:
0 : Performed after the data for all tool groups has been cleared.
1 : Performed by adding/changing or deleting the data for a specified
group.
NOTE
When EXG = 1, address Pin the block including Gl 0 can be
used to specify whether data is to be added/changed or
deleted (Pl: add/change, P2: delete). When P is not
specified, the data for all tool groups is cleared before the
tool life management data is registered.
- 298 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ lf--~--+~T=s=K-+~~-+-A=R=L--+~G=R=P-+~E~17~f--T=c=o--+~~=:~:--l
[Data type] Bit
T99 If a tool group whose life has expired is found to exist when M99 is
executed in the main program:
0 : The tool change signal is not output.
1 : The tool change signal is output.
TCO When function code 171or172 (tool life management data write) of the
PMC window function is specified, tool data of a tool in the currently
selected group that is currently not in use:
0 : Cannot be cleared.
1 : Can be cleared.
E17 When function code 171or172 (tool life management data write) of the
PMC window function is specified to clear tool life management data of
the tool currently in use in the currently selected group:
0 : The tool data is not cleared and operation terminates normally.
1 : The tool data is not cleared and completion code 13 is output.
GRP As management data for the tool life arrival notice signal (1LCHB):
0 : Parameters Nos. 6844 and 6845 are used.
1 : The value set for each group with the extended tool life management
function is used.
By setting the remaining life until new tool selection for each group, the
signal (1LCHB) is output when the value obtained by subtracting the tool
use count (COUNT) from the life setting (LIFE) reaches the value
(remaining life) set for each group.
ARL The tool life arrival notice signal (1LCHB) of tool life management is:
0 : Output for each tool.
1 : Output for the last tool in a group.
This parameteris valid only when bit 3 of parameter No. 6802 is setto I.
TSK When the life is specified by time and the last tool in a group is skipped in
tool life management:
0 : The count for the last tool indicates the life value.
1 : The count for the last tool is not changed.
-299-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then on again for the setting to become effective.
P3 L20;
(Omission of Q: The life of group 3 is specified as a count.)
Gll;
M30;
%
LFE When a tool life is specified by count:
0 : A count value from 0 to 9999 can be specified.
1 : A count value from 0 to 65535 can be specified.
- 300-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ ~1~~~~~~"-o-ol-lif~e-m-an-a-ge_m_e_nt-ig_n_or_ed_n_u_m_be_r~~~~~----1
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
This parameter sets the tool life management ignored number.
When the set value is subtracted from a T code, a remainder is used as the
tool group number of tool life management when a value exceeding the set
value is specified in the T code.
~ ~1~~~~~~~-Tu_o_lli_~_c_ou_n_tr_es_ra_rt_M_cod~•~~~~~~~---1
~ ~1~~~~~~~R-e_m_m-.n-ing_t_oo_l_life-(-us_e_c_ou_n_ij~~~~~~--1
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] Count
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
This parameter sets a remaining tool life (use count) used to output the
tool life arrival notice signal when the tool life is specified as a use count.
NOTE
1 When the remaining life (use count) of a selected tool
reaches the value specified with parameter No.6844, tool life
arrival notice signal TLCHB is output to the PMC.
2 If a value greater than the life of a tool is specified with
parameter No.6844, the tool life arrival notice signal is not
output.
- 301 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
~ ~1~~~~~~-R-em-a-in-in-g1-oo-l~li~-(-us-e-du_ra_ti-on-)~~~~~~~
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] min
[Valid data range] 0 to 4300
lbis parameter sets the remaining tool life (use duration), used to output
the tool life arrival notice signal when the tool life is specified as a use
duration.
NOTE
1 When the remaining life (use duration) of a selected tool
reaches the value specified in parameter No.6845, tool life
arrival notice signal TLCHB is output to the PMC. The tool
life management function allows the user to specify a tool life
either as a use duration or use count for each tool group. For
a group whose life is specified as a use count, parameter
No.6844 is used. For a group whose life is specified as a use
time, parameter No.6845 is used.
2 If a value greater than the life of a tool is specified with
parameter No.6845, the tool life arrival notice signal is not
output.
- 302-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.41
PARAMETERS OF
POSITION SWITCH #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
FUNCTIONS
NOTE
The position switch signals are output considering
acceleration/deceleration after interpolation and servo
delay. Acceleration/deceleration after interpolation and
servo delay are considered even for position switch signal
output in a mode other than the Al look-ahead control and
look-ahead control modes. When this parameter is set to 1,
however, signals are output from the position switches at
different times from the specified ones.
- 303 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
Set 0 for the number corresponding to a position switch
which is not to be used.
- 304-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
- 305 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 306-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.42
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL OPERATION
AND AUTOMATIC .----'#"""7~---"'#6'---T---"#5"'--~#4'-'--~""'#3'---,----'#2=----~#""'1~---"'"#00.,......,
OPERATION I 7001 11~-~-~-~-~-~-~-~-M_iN~
[Data type] Bit
MIN The manual intervention and return function is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
I 7015 I ~I_____L•_•_st_co_m_m_an_d_in_cre_me_n1_s_e11_1n_g_fo_ri_·og_f_eed_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Metric machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
- 307 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
- 308 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.43
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL HANDLE
FEED AND HANDLE
INTERRUPTION
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
7100 I l~-~--~--~-H_P_F~_H_C_L~_IH_D_~T_H_D~_J_H_D~
[Data type] Bit
JHD Manual handle feed in JOG feed mode or incremental feed in the manual
handlefeed
0: Invalid
1: Valid
WhanJHD:=O WhanJHD:=1
JOG load Manual handle JOG- Manual handle
mode feadmode mode feadmode
JOG food 0 x 0 x
Manual handle feed x 0 0 0
lncrementalfeed x x x 0
THD Manual pulse generator in TEACH IN JOG mode
0: Invalid
1: Valid
IHD The travel increment for manual handle interrupt is:
0 : Output unit, and acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is
disabled.
1 : Input unit, and acceleration/deceleration after interpolation is
enabled.
HCL The clearing of handle interruption amount display by soft key [CAN]
operation is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
HPF When a manual handle feed exceeding the rapid traverse rate is issued,
0 : The rate is clamped at the rapid traverse rate, and the handle pulses
corresponding to the excess are ignored. (The graduations of the
manual pulse generator may not agree with the distance the machine
has traveled.)
1 : The rate is clamped at the rapid traverse rate, and the handle pulses
corresponding to the excess are not ignored, but stored in the CNC. (If
the rotation of the manual pulse generator is stopped, the machine
moves by the distance corresponding to the pulses preserved in the
CNC, then stops.)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
7102 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-H_N_G~xI
[Data type] Bit axis
HNGx Axis movement direction for rotation direction of manual pulse generator
0 : Same in direction
1 : Reverse in direction
- 309-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
7103 I l~-~--~--~l_B_H~_H_IT~_H_N_T~_R_H_D~--~
[Data type] Bit
RHD By a reset, the amount of manual handle interruption is:
0 : Not canceled.
1 : Canceled.
NOTE
This parameter is valid when bit 2 (IHD) of parameter No.
7100 is set to 1.
I 7110 I ~I______N_um_b_er_of_m_an_u_a_Ip_u_lse_g_e_ne_ra_to_rs_u_sed_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 1 or 2 (T series), 3 (M series)
This parameter sets the number of manual pulse generators.
- 310-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7114 I ~I_______M_a_nu_a_lh_a_nd_le_fe_ed_m_ag_n_ifi_ca_ti_on_n_ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] One time
[Valid data range] 1 to 1000
This parameter sets the magnification when manual handle feed
movement selection signals MPl and MP2 are set to 1.
Movement Movement
selection signal (Manual handle-)
MP2 MP1
0 0 Least input incrementx 1
0 1 Least input increment x 1o
1 0 Least input increment x m
1 1 Least input incrementx n
7117 Allowable number of pulses that can be accumulated during manual handle feed
NOTE
If the specification of manual handle feed is such that the
rapid traverse rate will be exceeded, for example, when the
manual pulse generator is rotated at high speed with a large
magnification such as x 100, the axial feedrate is clamped
at the rapid traverse rate and those pulses received from the
manual pulse generator that exceed the rapid traverse rate
are ignored. In such a case, therefore, the scale on the
manual pulse generator may differ from the actual amount
of travel. If such a difference is not acceptable, this
parameter can be set to temporarily accumulate the excess
pulses in the CNC, rather than ignoring them, up to the
specified maximum (pulses in excess of the set maximum
are ignored). The accumulated pulses are output and
converted to a move command once the feedrate falls below
the rapid traverse rate by reducing the rotational speed of
the manual pulse generator or stopping its rotation
altogether. Note, however, that if the maximum number of
pulses to be accumulated is too large, stopping the rotation
of the manual pulse generator does not stop feeding until the
tool moves by an amount corresponding to the pulses
accumulated in the CNC.
- 311 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.44
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL LINE AND
ARC FUNCTIONS
7160
Approach handle clampfeedrate
11s1 I .~------~~~~~-~~---------1
Guidancehandleclampfeedrate
- 312 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.45
PARAMETERS OF
REFERENCE
POSITION SETTING
WITH MECHANICAL
STOPPER 7181 II First withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
NOTE
Set the same direction as that set in bit 5 (ZMlx) of parameter
No. 1006. Cycle operation cannot be started if the opposite
direction is set.
7182 I I Second withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper I
[Data type] 2-word axis
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Unit
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
NOTE
Set the same direction as that set in bit 5 (ZMlx) of parameter
No. 1006. Cycle operation cannot be started if the opposite
direction is set.
- 313 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
7183 First butting feed rate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
parameter sets the feedrate first used to hit the stopper on an axis.
I 7184 I I Second butting feed rate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
parameter sets the feedrate used to hit the stopper on an axis for a second
time.
EJ
[Data type] Word axis
Withdrawal feedrate (common to the first and second butting operations) in
reference position setting with mechanical stopper
When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
parameter sets the feedrate used for withdrawal along an axis after the
mechanical stopper has been hit.
I 7186 I ~I__To_rq_u_e_li_m_it_va_1u_e_in_r_ef_e_re_nc_e_po_s_H_io_n_sett_in_g_wi_·1_h_m_ec_h_an_ic_a_Is_to_p_pe_r_~
[Data type] Byte axes
[Unit of data] %
[Valid data range] 0 to 100
This parameter sets a torque limit value in reference position setting with
mechanical stopper
NOTE
When 0 is set in this parameter, 100% is assumed.
- 314 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.46
PARAMETERS OF
SOFTWARE
OPERATOR'S PANEL
#7 ~ ~ M ~ ~ ~ ~
#7 ~ ~ M ~ ~ #1 #0
7201 I l.___ _,____,___,___ _,____,___,___ _,__JP_C~
[Data type] Bit
JPC For the name of a general-purpose switch function on the software
operator's panel, the use of full-size characters is:
0 : Not allowed.
1: Allowed.
- 315 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS B--63610EN/01
7211 Job-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel r.LJ
7212 Job-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel [-+J
7213 r
Job-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel +--J
7214 Job-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel r ,..1
a
[Data type] Byte
Job-movement axis and its direction on software operator's panel r ~J
Example Under X, Y, and Z axis configuration, to set arrow keys to feed the axes
in the direction specified as follows, set the parameters to the values given
below. [8 tl to the positive direction of the Z axis, [2 il to the negative
direction of the Z axis, [6 --+] to the positive direction of the X axis [4-]
to the negative direction of the X axis, [111'] to the positive direction of
the Y axis, [91'] to the negative direction of the Y axis
Parameter No.7210 = 5 (Z axis, positive direction)
Parameter No.7211 = 6 (Z axis, negative direction)
Parameter No.7212 = 1 (X axis, positive direction)
Parameter No.7213 =2 (X axis, negative direction)
Parameter No.7214 =3 (Y axis, positive direction)
Parameter No.7215 =4 (Y axis, negative direction)
Parameter No.7216 = 0 (Not used)
ParameterNo.7217 = 0 (Not used)
- 316-
B--63610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7283 I ~l~~~N_a_m_em~ge_n_e_ra_l-p_u_r_pos_e_sw~it_ch_o_n_softwa~-r_e_ope~ra_ro_r_~_pa_n_el~~---'
[Data type] Byte
Example
These parameters set the OPERATOR'S PANEL 01234 N5678
names of the
general-purpose switches
(SIGNAL 1 through
SIGNALl
SIGNAL2
SIGNAL3
: C•ij#
OFF
OFF
•·E•
•·E•
ON
SIGNAL 8) on the
software operator's panel
as described below.
SIGNAL4
SIGNALS
SIGNAL6
:: •·O•
M•if1#
: M1i)#
ON
ON
ON
: M·iiM
SIGNAL?
SIGNALS OFF •·B•ON
These names are set using character codes that are displayed in parameter
Nos. 7220 to 7283.
Parameter No.7220:
Sets the character code (083) corresponding to S of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7221:
Sets the character code (073) corresponding to I of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7222:
Sets the character code (071) corresponding to G of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7223:
Sets the character code (078) corresponding to N of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7224:
Sets the character code (065) corresponding to A of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7225:
Sets the character code (076) corresponding to L of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7226:
Sets the character code (032) corresponding to (space) of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter No.7227:
Sets the character code (049) corresponding to 1 of SIGNAL 1.
Parameter Nos. 7228 to 7235:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 2 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7236 to 7243:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 3 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7244 to 7251:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 4 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7252 to 7259:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 5 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7260 to 7267:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 6 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7268 to 7275:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 7 shown in the figure above.
Parameter Nos. 7276 to 7283:
Set the character codes of SIGNAL 8 shown in the figure above.
The character codes are shown in Appendix A CHARACTER CODE
LIST.
- 317 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
These names are set using the character codes displayed in parameters
No.7284 through No.7299, aod parameters No.7352 through No.7399.
ParameterNo.7284:
Set the character code (083) corresponding to S of SIGNAL 9.
ParameterNo.7285:
Set the character code (073) corresponding to I of SIGNAL 9.
ParameterNo.7286:
Set the character code (071) corresponding to G of SIGNAL 9.
Parameter No.7287:
Set the character code (078) corresponding to N of SIGNAL 9.
Parameter No.7288:
Set the character code (065) corresponding to A of SIGNAL 9.
Parameter No.7289:
Set the character code (076) corresponding to L of SIGNAL 9.
Parameter No.7290:
Set the chanmr code (032) corresponding to (space) of SIGNAL 9.
Parameter No.7291:
Set the character code (057) corresponding to 9 of SIGNAL 9.
Similarly, set character codes as shown below.
ParameterNo.7292 to No.7299: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 10,shownabove.
ParameterNo.7352 to No.7359: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 11, shown above.
ParameterNo.7360 to No.7367: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 12,shownabove.
ParameterNo.7368 to No.7375: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 13,shownabove.
ParameterNo.7376 to No.7383: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 14,shownabove.
ParameterNo.7384 to No.7391: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 15,shownabove.
ParameterNo.7392 to No.7399: SetcharactercodesforSIGNAL 16,shownabove.
The character codes are shown in the character code correspondence table
in Appendix A.
- 318 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.47
PARAMETERS OF
PROGRAM RESTART #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
MOU MOA
MOU MOA SJG
NOTE
This parameter is enabled when the MOU parameter is set
to 1.
- 319 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.48
PARAMETERS OF
HIGH-SPEED
MACHINING (HIGH-
SPEED REMOTE #7 #6 #5 #4 #1
#3 #2 #0
BUFFER) 1501 I l~1_P_c~~1r_2~~1_r1~~-1r_o~~~~~~~~~~~~
[Data type] Bit
ITO, ITl, IT2
IT2 IT1 ITO Interpolation of G05 data (ms)
0 0 0 8
0 0 1 2
0 1 0 4
0 1 1 1
1 0 0 16
IPC
0 : The system does not monitor whether a distribution process is
stopped with high-speed remote buffer A or B.
1 : The system monitors whether a distribution process is stopped with
high-speed remote buffer A or B.
(PIS alarms 179 and 000 are simultaneously issued if the distribution
process is stopped. In this case, the power must be turned off then on
again.)
NOTE
The distribution process stops, when the host cannot send
data with the high-speed remotebuffer by the specified time.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
- 320-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
After setting this parameter, the power must be tuned off
then on again.
I 7510 I ~I_____No_.o_f_co_nt_ro_lled_ax_e_s_in_hi_gh_-s_pe_ed_re_m_o_te_buff_er_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 1 to 4
This parameter sets the number of control axes in a high-speed remote
buffer.
- 321 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.49
PARAMETERS OF
POLYGON TURNING
#7 #6
~ 1>--~--+~~--+-~co_F~f--H_S_T--+~H_S_L--+-~HD_R~f--s_N_G--+~M_N_G_,
NOTE
Use MNG, SNG, and HDR when the specified rotational
direction of the master axis or polygon synchronization axis,
or the specified phase shift direction is to be reversed in
spindle-spindle polygon turning mode.
322 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
This parameter can be used, for example, when
single-rotation signal detection cannot be guaranteed at an
arbitrary feedrate because a separate detector is installed to
detect the spindle single-rotation signal, as when a built-in
spindle is used. (When bit 7 of parameter No.4016 for the
serial spindle is set to 1, together with this parameter, a
single-rotation signal detection position in spindle-spindle
polygon turning mode is guaranteed.)
NOTE
When the use of phase control is not selected, the steady state
is reached in a shorter time because phase synchronization
control is not applied. Once steady rotation is achieved,
however, polygonal turning must be completed without
changing the steady state. (If the rotation is stopped, or the
rotational speed altered, polygonal turning is disabled because
of the inevitable phase shift.) Even when this parameter is set
to 1, an R command (phase position command) in a block
containing G51.2 is ignored ; no alarm is issued.
~ l+--P_S_T--+~~-+--R_DG~+--~--+~PL_R--+~s_B_R-+-_o_o_R--+~R-PL--+
NOTE
This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
synchronization function is used.
1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
turning function option.
2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
3 Parameter Nos. 7635 and 7636 also need be set up.
- 323 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
PLR The machine coordinates of a tool axis for polygon turning are:
0 : Rounded by the setting in parameter 7620.
1 : Rounded by 360° (or the setting in parameter No. 1260 when bit 0
(ROA) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1).
RDG On the diagnosis screen No.476, for spindle-spindle polygon phase
command value (R), displays:
0 : The specified value (in the increment system for the rotation axis).
1 : The actual number of shift pulses.
NOTE
A phase command is specified in address R, in units of
degrees. For control, the actual shift amount is converted to
a number of pulses according to the conversion formula: 360
degrees= 4096 pulses. This parameter switches the display
of a specified value to that of a converted value.
PST The polygon spindle stop signal *PLSST (bit 0 of G038) is:
0: Not used.
1: Used.
1::1
LJ Control axis number of tool rotation axis for polygon turning
t-----------------------1
1::-1
~
Movement of tool rotation axis per revolution
t-----------------------1
- 324-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
l::"l
~
Maximum allowable speed for the tool rotation axis (polygon synchronization axis)
t------------------------l
l::"l
~
Allowable spindle speed deviation level in spindle-spindle polygon turning
t------------------------l
1::1
LJ Steady state confirmation time duration in spindle polygon turning
t------------------------l
- 325 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
r:::"l f - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - l
LJ Multiplierinfluencing the slave spindle speed
NOTE
This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
synchronization function is used.
1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
turning function option.
2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
3 Parameter Nos. 7603#2 and 7636 also need be set up.
B ~1------U_PP_•_rli_m_1to_r_1h_es_1a_v_••_P_in_dle_s_pe_ed
_ _ _ _ _ _--l
NOTE
This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
synchronization function is used.
1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
turning function option.
2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
3 Parameter Nos. 7603#2 and 7635 also need be set up.
- 326-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
r-:::::'l
LJ Master axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning
t-----------------------<
r-::::-1
LJ Polygoon synchronus axis in spindle-spindle polygon turning
t-----------------------1
NOTE
1 Spindle-spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial
spindles.
2 When either of parameters No. 7640 and No. 7641 is set to
0, the first spindle (master axis) and second spindle (polygon
synchronous axis) are used for polygon turning.
3 When the second serial spindle is used as a master axis, and
the S command is to be used for the master axis, the
multi-spindle control option is required.
4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used
to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the
block specifying the spindle-spindle polygon command
G51.2 (G251). When the PMC window function is used to
rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2
(G251 ), specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an
M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering.
- 327 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.50
PARAMETERS OF
AXIS CONTROL BY
PMC aoo1 I l~s_K_E~_A_u_x~~N_cc~~~~~RD_E~~o_v_E~~~~-M_LE~
[Data type] Bit
MLE Whether all axis machine lock signal MLK is valid for PMC--<:ontrolled
axes
0: Valid
1 : Invalid
NOTE
Each-axis machine lock signals MLK1 to MLK4 are always
valid, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
OVE Signals related to dry run and override used in PMC axis control
0: Same signals as those used for the CNC
(1) Feedrate override signals *FVO to *FV7
(2) Override cancellation signal OVC
(3) Rapid traverse override signals ROVl and ROV2
(4) Dry run signal DRN
(5) Rapid traverse selection signal RT
1: Signals specific to the PMC
(1) Feedrate override signals *FVOE to *FV7E
(2) Override cancellation signal OVCE
(3) Rapid traverse override signals ROVlE and ROV2E
(4) Dry run signal DRNE
(5) Rapid traverse selection signal RTE
RDE Whether dry run is valid for rapid traverse in PMC axis control
0: Invalid
1: Valid
NCC When a travel command is issued for a PMC--<:antrolled axis (selected by
a controlled-axis selection signal) according to the program:
0 : P/S alarm 139 is issued while the PMC controls the axis with an axis
control command. While the PMC does not control the axis, a CNC
command is enabled.
1 : P/S alarm 139 is issued unconditionally.
AUX The number of bytes for the code of an auxiliary function (12H) command
to be output is
0: 1 (Oto255)
1 : 2 (0 to 65535)
SKE Skip signal during axis control by the PMC
0 : Uses the same signal SKIP (X004#7) as CNC.
1 : Uses dedicated axis control signal ESKlP (X004#6) used by the
PMC.
- 328 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
eoo2 I l~F_R2_~_F_R_1~-P_F2_~P_F_1~_F_1_o~_su_E_~o_w_E~_R_P_o~
[Data type] Bit
RPD Rapid traverse rate for PMC--<:ontrolled axes
0 : Feedrate specified with parameter No.1420
1 : Feedrate specified with the feedrate data in an axis control command
DWE Minimum time which can be specified in a dwell command in PMC axis
control when the increment system is IS-C
0: 1 ms
1: 0.1 ms
SUE Whether acceleration/deceleration is performed for an axis that is
synchronized with external pulses, for external pulse synchronization
commands in PMC axis control
0 : Performed (exponential acceleration/deceleration)
1 : Not performed
FlO Least increment for the feedrate for cutting feed (per minute) in PMC axis
control
F10 Mllllmatar Input Inch Input
0 1 mm/min 0.01 inch/min
1 10 mm/min 0.1 inch/min
PFl, PF2 Set the the feedrate unit of feed per minute in PMC axis control
PF2 PF1 Feedrate unit
0 0 1/1
0 1 1/10
1 0 1/100
1 1 1/1000
FRl, FR2 Set the feedrate unit for feed per rotation for an axis controlled by the
PMC.
FR2 FR1 Millimeter input Inch input
0 0
0.0001 mm/rev 0.000001 inch/rev
1 1
0 1 0.001 mm/rev 0.00001 inch/rev
1 0 0.01 mm/rev 0.0001 inch/rev
- 329-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8004 NDI NCI DSL NMT CMV
NCI DSL GBR GBC NMT CMV
CMV When a move command and auxiliary function are specified from the
CNC, and the system is awaiting the auxiliary function completion signal
after completion of the specified axis movement:
0 : An alarm (No.130) is issued when an axis control command is issued
from the PMC for the same axis.
1 : An axis control command, when issued from the PMC for the same
axis, is executed.
NMT When a command is specified from the CNC for the axis on which the tool
is moving according to axis control specification from the PMC:
0 : PIS alarm No.130 is issued.
1 : The command is executed without issuing an alarm, provided the
command does not involve a movement on the axis.
GSC Look--fillead control for the axes controlled by the PMC is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
NOTE
This parameter is valid for an axis for which bit 7 (NAHx) of
parameter No.1819 is set to 0.
NOTE
This parameter is valid for an axis for which bit 7 (NAHx) of
parameter No.1819 is set to 0.
- 330-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
DSL If the selection of an axis is changed when PMC axis selection is disabled:
0: P/S alarm No.139 is issued.
1 : The change is valid, and no alarm is issued for an unspecified system.
NCI In axis control by the PMC, a position check at the time of deceleration is:
0 : Performed.
1 : Not performed.
NDI For PMC axis control, when diameter programming is specified for a
PMC--<:ontrolled axis:
0 : The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a radius.
1 : The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a diameter.
NOTE
NDI is valid for an axis for which diameter programming is
specified (bit 3 (DIAx) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 1)
when bit 1 (CDI) of parameter No. 8005 is set to 0.
aoos I l~M_F_D~--~-1_Fv_~-~-DR_R~_R_1_0~-c_o_1~_Eo_c~
[Data type] Bit
EDC In PMC-based axis control, an external deceleration signal is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
CDI For PMC axis control, when diameter programming is specified for a
PMC--<:ontrolled axis:
0 : The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a radius.
1 : The amount of travel is specified with a diameter while the feedrate is
specified with a radius.
NOTE
1 This parameter is valid when bit 3 (DIA) of parameter
No.1006 is set to 1.
2 When CDI is set to 1, bit 7 (NDI) of parameter No.8004 is
disabled.
RIO When the RPD parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.8002) is set to 1, the unit
for specifying a rapid traverse rate for the PMC axis is:
0: 1 mm/min.
1 : 10 mm/min.
DRR For cutting feed per rotation in PMC axis control, the dry run function is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
IFV Override for each group in PMC axis control is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
MFD Output by each auxiliary function of the PMC axis control function is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
- 331 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8008 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-M_l_Rx~
[Data type] Bit axis
MIRx When a PMC axis control command is issued in mirror image mode, the
mirror image is:
0 : Not considered.
1 : Considered.
This parameter is valid when PMC signals Mll to MIS <bits 0 to 7 of
G106> are set to "1" or bit 0 (MIRx) of parameter No. 0012 is set to "l".
- 332-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
If 0 is specified, the value of parameter No. 1425 is used.
8021 Minimum speed of rapid traverse override in axis control by PMC (Fa)
I 8022 I ~l~~~U_p_pe_r_~_im_H_ra_1e_m~fee~d_P•_•_~_vo_1_u1_io_n_d_ur_in_g_P_M_c_""'_._•_co_n_1ro_1~~--'
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data]
[Valid data range]
Valid data range
Increment system Unit data
IS-B IS-C
Millimeter machine 1 mm/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
Inch machine 0.1 inch/min 6 to 6000 6 to 4800
Rotation axis 1 deg/min 6 to 15000 6 to 12000
This parameter sets the upper limit rate offeed per revolution during PMC
axis control.
NOTE
The upper limit specified for the first axis is valid for all axes.
The specifications for the second and subsequent axes are
ignored.
8028 Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for speed commands for PMC axis control
NOTE
If this parameter is set to 0, acceleration/deceleration control
is not applied.
- 333 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.51
PARAMETERS OF
ANGULAR AXIS
CONTROL #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
~ #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 ~ #0
~ l>--A_D_G--+~~-+-~A_CL~>--~--+~~-+-~A03~-+--A_0_2--+~A-O_T_,
- 334-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
ACL In linear interpolation type rapid traverse, the feedrate clamp function for
angular axis control is:
0: Enabled.
1 : Disabled.
NOTE
This parameter is valid when bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No.
1401 is set to 1.
ADG The contents of diagnostic data Nos. 306 and 307 are:
0 : Not swapped. The angular axis and Cartesian axis are displayed in
this order.
1 : Swapped. The Cartesian axis and angular axis are displayed in this
order.
e : Inclination angle
- 335 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.52
PARAMETERS OF
B-AXIS CONTROL
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ lf--M_S_T--+~A_BS~+--so_v~f--T_E_M--+~R_E_F-+~~-+-~~+-~---1
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ lf--~--+~~-+~~-+-~~+-~~+--M_DF~f--M_D_G--+~F_x_c--l
- 336-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ r1~~~~~~~Ax_is_n_u_m_b_er_u_sed~ro_r_B-ax~_is_co~nt_ro_I~~~~~~-;
B
M code (G101) for specifying the start of first program operation
EJ
[Data type] 2-word
M code (Gt 03) for specifying the start of third program operation
~ r1~~~~~~T_c_od_e_n_u_m_be_r_ro_r_to_o_loff~sm~ca_n_ce_ll_m_io_n~~~~~---1
- 337 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
B
[Data type] 2-word
Clearance, used in canned cycle G83, for the B-axis
lJ G83
~ .... ' ~
' ' ' '' ' '
q : Depth of cut
q ' ' '
~I
' '' ' d d : Clearance
' ' '
'
' ''
'
'' '
q ~
' '
'
d
~I
' '
' '
- - - -> Rapid traverse
'
'
' '
q ' --+ Cutting feed
I
' d
' I
Point B
- 338 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.53
PARAMETERS OF
SIMPLE
SYNCHRONOUS
CONTROL
[Data type] Bit
SYA In the servo-off state in simple synchronous control, the limit of the
difference between the positioning deviation of the master axis and that of
the slave axis is:
0 : Not checked.
1: Checked.
SYE During executioo of syochronization, the limit of the difference between
positioning deviations (parameter No. 8313 or 8323) is:
0: Checked.
1 : Not checked.
SOF The syochronization funciton in simple syochronous control (one pair) is:
0: Not used.
1: Used.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
~ lt--s~M-A--+~~-+-~~t--~--+~SS~E--t~~-+--A-"~s--+~AT-E--+
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
1 When the bits are set to 1, parameter No.8316 and bit 4
(APZX) of parameter No.1815 for the master and slave axes
are set to 0.
2 These bits are automatically set to 0 once grid positioning
has been completed.
- 339-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
The simple synchronous signal must be manipulated.
Carefully turn the simple synchronous signal on and off
because the machine may move at that time.
~ lt--so~Fx--+1~~--+-~~-+-~~-+-~~+-~~t--A-J-Sx--+~AT_Ex__,
NOTE
After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
off then on again for the setting to become effective.
NOTE
When starting automatic setting for grid positioning, set
ATSx to 1. Upon the completion of setting, ATSx is
automatically set to 0.
NOTE
Set this parameter on the master axis side.
- 340-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
Set this parameter (USD) to the same value for both the
master and slave axes.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
NOTE
This parameter is valid only when bit 7 (SOF) of parameter
No. 8301 or bit 7 (SOFx) of parameter No. 8303 is set to 1.
NOTE
This parameter is valid only when bit 7 (SOF) of parameter
No. 8301 or bit 7 (SOFx) of parameter No. 8303 is set to 1.
- 341 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
For an axis for which 0 is set, the first axis serves as the
master axis. So, when the control signal for the axis is set
to 1, the first axis serves as a master axis, and synchronous
control is exercised.
- 342-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
NOTE
In Example 2 above, the Z axis, which is the master axis of
the M Series, is used as the slave axis of another axis. This
usage may prevent other functions from operating normally.
When exercising simple synchronous control with two pairs,
take care.
NOTE
The axis number of a master axis must always be smaller
than the corresponding slave axis number. Multiple slave
axes cannot be assigned to a master axis.
r:::l t - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 1
LJ Enabling/disablingmirror image in synchronous control
- 343 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Limit of the difference between the amount of positioning deviation of the master
and slave axes (Synchronous control one pair)
~ ~1~~~~~~M~ax~i-m-um~a,-ro-r~in_sy_n_c~hro~ni-za~ti-on_a_rr_o_rc~h-ack~~~~~---1
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data]
Increment system IS-A IS-B IS-C Units
Millimeter machine 0.01 0.001 0.0001 mm
Inch machine 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 inch
Rotation axis 0.01 0.001 0.0001 deg
- 344-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ f---------~-----~----------1
L..:.:.J Maximum compensation value for synchronization (Synchronous control one pair)
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
r::l
LJ .__D_iff_•_r•_nc_•_be1wee
(Synchronous _control
_"_'ef_•_r•_n_ce_c_o_un_t•_rs_fo_r_m_ast_•r_•_nd_•_l•_••_ax_es
one pair) _ _ _ __,
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
NOTE
Once grid positioning has been completed, the difference
between the reference counters is automatically set in this
parameter. At this time, bit 1 (ATS) of parameter No.8302 is
set to 0.
~
~
f---~-~--~~-~~~-~---~-~----1
Torque difference alarm detection time (Synchronous control one pair)
- 345 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
Detection timer for the limit of the difference between the positioning deviation of
the master axis and that of the slave axis
NOTE
If a value greater than 1000 is set, a value of 1000 is
assumed.
1::-1
L.::J Maximum allowable difference between master axis and slave axis positional deviations
B
[Data type] Word axis
Maximum compensation value for synchronization
- 346-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
EJ
[Data type] 2-word axis
Difference between master axis and slave axis reference counters
~ ~1~~~~~~~To~~-u-e-d~iff~e~~nc_e_a~larm~d~m-ect~io-n~ti-m-er~~~~~~--1
[Data type] Word axis
[Unit of data] ms
[Valid data range] 0 to 4000
This parameter sets a time from the servo preparation completion signal,
SA (F000#6), being set to 1 until torque difference alarm detection is
started in simple synchronous control. A fraction of less than 16 msec is
rounded up.
Example: Setting= 100: The specification of 112 msec is assumed.
Set this parameter with a master axis. If 0 is set in this parameter, the
specification of 512 msec is assumed.
- 347 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.54
PARAMETERS OF
CHECK
TERMINATION
8341 Program number subject to check tennination
NOTE
A program number can also be set on the setting screen. If
a program number is set on the setting screen, the value of
the parameter is changed accordingly.
8342 I ~I_____s_eq_u_en_ce_nu_m_be_r_s_ub_i•_ct_to_c_h_ec_k_te_rm_i_na_ti_on____~
[Data type] 2-word
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
This parameter sets the sequence nwnber subject to sequence nwnber
check termination.
If the block containing the sequence nwnber set with this parameter is
executed while the program set with parameter No.8341 is being
executed, a single block stop occurs after the block is executed. At this
time, the setting is automatically set to -1. Upon power-up, the setting
is automatically set to 0.
NOTE
A sequence number can also be set by using the setting
screen. If a sequence number is set on the setting screen,
the value of the parameter is changed accordingly.
- 348 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.55
#7 #6
OTHER
PARAMETERS
8650 I l.__~-'-~~-'--P-G_u_.__c_K_M_,_~oM_A__.~E-KY~'--c-N_A-'-~Rs_K__.
[Data type] Bit
RSK When the RESET key is pressed, the key code is:
0 : Not passed to the application in the C executor.
1 : Passed to the application in the C executor.
CNA When an NC alarm is issued during the display of the user screen for the C
executor:
0 : The NC alarm screen can be displayed depending on the setting of bit
7 (NPA) ofparameterNo.3111.
1 : The NC alarm screen is not displayed.
EKY When the C language executor is used, the extended portion of the MDI
keys (9 to 11 lines) is:
0: Not read.
1: Read.
DMA When the C language executor is used, transfer via RS--232-C is:
0 : Not made as OMA transfer.
1 : Made as OMA transfer.
CKM When the C language executor is used, the bit matrix of the MDI keys is:
0 : Not transferred to the NC.
1 : Transferred to the NC.
Set this bit to 1 only when the NC needs to directly read the bit matrix.
Usually, set this bit to 0.
PGU When the user screen for the C executor is assigned as an NC program
screen:
0 : The common screen number is used.
1 : The screen number for each operation mode is used.
NOTE
Bits 0 to 5 of this parameter is used with the C executor. Any
modifications to the value set for bits 0 to 5 of this parameter
does not become effective until after the system is next
powered on.
#7 #6 #1
8651 I l~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~CF_S~
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is contimued.
- 349-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
8661 I ~I_________va_n_ab_le_a_re_a_siz_•_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] KByte
[Valid data range] 0 to 59 (251)
This parameter specifies the size of the static variable area that can be
shared by tasks of C executer. The maximum size is 59K bytes (251K
bytes if an optional 256KB SRAM is added). The total of the SRAM disk
size (parameter No. 8662) and the value of this parameter should not
exceed the available SRAM size minus lK bytes (that is, 63K or 255K
bytes).
NOTE
This parameter is used for C executer. When this setting is
changed, the variable area is initialized. A change in this
setting is applied at the next power-up or later.
8662 I ~l_________s_RA_M_di_sk_s_i~----------'
[Data type] Word
[Unit of data] KByte
[Valid data range] 4 to 63 (255)
This parameter specifies the SRAM disk size in C executer. Specify a
value greater than or equal to 4K bytes in lK-byte units. The maximum
size is 63K bytes (255K bytes if the optional 256KB SRAM is added).
The total of the variable area size (parameter No. 8661) and the value of
this parameter should not exceed the available SRAM size minus lK
bytes (that is, 63K or 255K bytes).
NOTE
This parameter is used for C executer. When this setting is
changed, the SRAM disk is initialized. A change in this
setting is applied at the next power-up or later.
8663 I ~l_________TI_m_ez_o_n•_~_tt_in_g_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word
[Unit of data] s
[Valid data range] -12*3600 to 12*3600
This parameter specifies the time-zone difference from Greenwich Mean
Time in seconds. The difference for Japan is -9 hours. (The setting is
-9*3600 = 32400)
NOTE
This parameter is used for C executer. A change in this
setting is applied at the next power-up or later.
- 350-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8700 I l~----'----'---~----L-D_M_M~--~--~-~
[Data type] Bit
DMM In DNC operation from the PMC, OPEN CNC, or C-EXE, pre-reading
is:
0 : Not performed.
1 : Performed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8701 I l~----'----'---~----'----'--w-P_R~-P-L_D---'----'
[Data type] Bit
PLD When the P--<:ode loader function is used (macro compiler/executor):
0 : AM is initialized and the entire contents of RAM are rewritten.
1 : RAM is not initialized, being overwritten instead
WPR The function that allows parameters that are rewritten using the PMC
window to be enabled during automatic operation is:
0 : Disabled.
1: Enabled.
NOTE
If this parameter is set, a move command based on manual
operation is disabled (interlock state) while parameter
rewriting using the PMC window is being executed.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8702 I l~L_F_M---'----'---~----'----'---~----L---'
[Data type] Bit
LFM At the beginning of program uploading in response to a request using the
data window library:
0 : ''LF+%" is not output.
1 : ''LF+%" is output.
- 351 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
#7 1#6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
e1os I l.___ _,____,___,___ _,____,___,__N_w_o_,__Hs_o__,
NOTE
When this parameter has been set, the power must be
turned off before operation is contimued.
NOTE
For details of this parameter, also refer to "FANUC Open
CNC DNC Operation Management Package" and other
manuals.
NWD During DNC operation with FOCASl/HSSB, new DNC functions are:
0 : Not executed.
1 : Executed.
When this parameter is set, the Ml98 command (subprogram call) can
also be executed with FOCAS l/HSSB.
NOTE
To execute the M198 command with FOCAS1/HSSB,
parameter No. 20 must be set to "15".
For details of this parameter, also refer to "FANUC Open
CNC DNC Operation Management Package" and other
manuals.
- 352-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
~ ~Pr-og_ra_m_n_um_be_•f-or_d_ata_re_g_i•_t•-•t-io_n
L.:.:J _ 110 link) (_da-ta-in_p_ut!_o_ut_pu_tf_u_nct-io_n_u•_in_g_th_•_ _~
NOTE
When 0 is set, the inpuVoutput of parameters, macro
variables, and diagnostic data cannot be performed, but
program inpuVoutput processing is performed.
8781 I ~I_____A_m_o_un_1o_f_D_RA_M_u_se_d_wi_·1_ht_he_c_ex_ecu_10_r----~
NOTE
When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
before operation is continued.
- 353 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
The available size depends on the amount of installed
DRAM and the selected options.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8801 I
[Data type] Bit
Bit parameter 1 for machine tool builder
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8802
NOTE
These parameters are used only by the machine tool builder.
Refer to the relevant manual supplied by the machine tool
builder for details.
8812 I ~I______2-w_o_rd_par_am_et_e_r_2_1o_rm_ac_hi_ne_t_oo_Ib_u_ild_e_r----~
8813 I ~I______2-w_o_rd_par_am_et_e_r_a_fo_rm_a_c_hi_ne_t_oo_Ib_u_ild_e_r- - - - - - - '
[Data type] 2-word
[Valid data range] -99999999 to 99999999
NOTE
These parameters are used only by the machine tool builder.
Refer to the relevant manual supplied by the machine tool
builder for details.
- 354-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.56
PARAMETERS OF
MAINTENANCE #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8901 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-FA_N~
[Data type] Bit
FAN A fan motor error is:
0 : Detected. (When the fan motor erroris detected, an overheating alarm
occurs.)
1 : Not detected. (Use inhibited)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
8903 I l~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-PR_M~
[Data type] Bit
PRM A periodic maintenance expiration message is:
0 : Not displayed.
1 : Displayed.
I 8911 II Ratio of the items on the periodic maintenance screen to the respective lives
8940 I ~I________TI_11e_c_hara_c1_e_rco_d_e_1_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
8941 I ~I________TI_11e_c_ha_ra_c1_e_rc_od_e_2_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
8949 I ~I________TI_11_1e_ch_a_rac1_er_cod_e_10_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] See below.
When the CNC is turned on, up to ten characters specified in these
parameters are displayed on the screen showing the series and edition of
theCNC.
• The following characters can be used.
0 to 9, A to Z, - (minus sign), . (period), and space
• The character codes to be specified are listed in the character code list
in Appendix A.
• If any code other than those character codes that can be specified is
specified, a space is displayed.
- 355 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.57
PARAMETERS OF
BUILT-IN MACRO
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
112001 11~-~--~-~--~-~--~-~-IM_R~
[Data type] Bit
IMR If an attempt is made to enter a program having the same program number
as a built-in macro program that has already been entered,
0: An alarm is raised.
1: The built-in program is deleted, then the new program is entered.
However, if the built-in program is edit-prohibited, the program is
not deleted, but an alarm is raised.
REP IMREP Program stored Bullt-ln macro
(Prm.No.3201 #2) (Prm.No.12001#0) on tape program
0 0 Alarm Alarm
0 1 Alarm Overwrite
1 0 Overwrite Alarm
1 1 Overwrite Overwrite
NOTE
1 This parameter is rewritten by the built-in macro data in
FROM at power-up or at a reload operation.
2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built-in
macro data in FROM is used.
I 12010 I ~I___B_u_ilt_-i_nm_a_cr_o_pr_og_ra_m_r_ef_er_en_ci_ng_o_re_d_iti_ng_e_na_b_ledl_d_is_ab_l_ed_ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 0 to 2
This parameter specifies whether referencing or editing of a built-in
macro program is enabled or disabled.
Prm.No.1201 O Edit Reference
0 x x
1 x 0
2 0 0
NOTE
1 This parameter is rewritten by the built-in macro data in
FROM at power-up or at a reload operation.
2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built-in
macro data in FROM is used.
- 356-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 12011 I ~I_______R_rst_b_u_ilt-_i_nm_ac_ro_p_ro_g_ra_m_n_um_be_r-----~
I 12012 I ~I_______Las_tb_u_ilt-t_._nm_a_c_ro_p_ro_g_ra_m_n_um_be_r-----~
[Data type] 2-word
[Valid data range] 1 to 9999
These parameters specify built-in macro programs by specifying the first
and last program nwnbers. The other programs are part program storage
programs.
Example: Sample four-digit program nwnbers
Parameter No.12011=1234
Parameter No.12012=5678
J,
Built-in macro program nwnber = 01234 to 05678
Part program storage program nwnber = 00001 to 01233
05679 to 09999
NOTE
1 This parameter is rewritten by the built-in macro data in
FROM at power-up or at a reload operation.
2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built-in
macro data in FROM is used.
3 This parameter cannot be changed if a key for built-in macro
is locked or if at least a single NC program is provided.
I 12013 I ~I_______Pa_s_sw_o_rdlk_e_ywo_rd_1o_r_bu_il_H_·n_m_a_cr_o_ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] 2-word
[Valid data range] -99999999 to 99999999
A password is specified to store a built-in macro program in FROM.
After the built-in macro program is stored, this parameter is set to 0.
Otherwise, this parameter is used as a keyword input area. (After
power-up, this parameter is set to 0.)
If the password matches the keyword, the key for built-in macro is
unlocked. If the password does not match the keyword, the key for
built-in macro is locked. If the password is 0 and if FROM does not
include INMC, the key for built-in macro is unlocked, irrespective of the
keyword.
• If locked, abuilt-inmacroprogramcannotbesaved. As the data items
of 1 to 5 listed below, the corresponding data items of built-in macro
in FROM are used.
• If unlocked, a built-in macro program can be saved. As the data items
of 1 to 5 listed below, the corresponding parameter settings are used.
1. Built-in macro program entry and overwrite disabled (bit 0 of
parameter No. 12001)
2. Built-in macro program referencing and editing enabled/disabled
(parameter No. 12010)
- 357 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
NOTE
1 If the password is not zero, the password cannot be changed
for the built-in macro data.
2 If all of the following conditions are satisfied, the keyword
cannot be changed.
1) A password is specified. (Password is not zero.)
2) The macro program number range of the built-in data of
FROM is different from the built-in macro program
number range specified in the parameter.
3)A program is entered.
I 12015 I ~-------S-•r_ies_ro_r_b_ui_IH_·n_m_a_cro_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
I 12016 I ~I________E_dH_io_n_fo_rb_u_ih-t_'n_m_a_cro_ _ _ _ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 0 to 9999
These parameters specify the series and edition of the FROM file for
built-in macro. The series and edition are placed in the FROM file when
the built-in macro data is saved and can be checked on the system
configuration screen.
NOTE
1 This parameter is rewritten by the built-in macro data in
FROM at power-up or at a reload operation.
2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built-in
macro data in FROM is used.
3 If this parameter is set to 0, the series or edition of the FROM
file for built-in macro is not displayed on the system
configuration screen.
112020 I ~I_____G_co_de_n_u_m_be_rro_r_b_ui_lt-_in_m_ac_r_o(_firs_t_set_)----~
I 12023 I ~I_____G_cod_e_n_u_m_be_rf_o_rb_ui_IH_'n_m_ac_ro_(se_c_on_d_set_)_ _ _ _~
112047 I ~l_____G_c_od_e_n_um_be_r_ro_r_bu_ilt_~_n_m_ac_ro_(t_en_th_•_•_n_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 1 to 999
- 358 -
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
I 12024 I ~I_____Pr_o_gr_am_nu_m_be_r_fo_r_bu_i1_1-_in_m_ac_ro_(_se_c_o_nd_s_e1_)----~
I 12048 I ~I_____P_rog_ram_n_u_m_be_r_fo_rb_u_ilt-1_·_nm_a_c_ro_(t_e_nt_hset_)_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Word
[Valid data range] 1 to 9999
I 12022 I ~I_____G_c_od_e_m_a_cr_o_co_u_nt_fo_r_bu_ilt_,..;_n_m_ac_ro_(_firs_t_set_)----~
I 12025 I ~I_____G_co_d_e_m_a_cr_o_co_u_n1_1o_r_bu_ilt_-_in_m_ac_ro_(_se_co_n_d_s_et_)---~
I 12049 I ~I_____G_cod_e_m_ac_ro_co_u_n_tf_o_rb_u_itt-1_·n_m_a_cro_(t_ent_h_se_tl_ _ _ _~
[Data type] Byte
[Valid data range] 1 to 255
These parameters specify G code macros for built-in macros. A G code,
corresponding macro program number, and corresponding G code count
are specified. Up to ten sets of these items can be specified. If identical
G code numbers are found, the one in a younger set takes priority. If any
of the G code number, macro program number, and count is 0, the set is
invalid.
Example: Suppose that built-in macro program numbers are 7000 to 8999.
First sat Second set Third set
Geode No.12020·100 No.12023·150 No.12026·900
Onumber No.12021 ·8000 No.12024-7500 No.12027-8300
Count No.12022·10 No.12025-100 No.12028-30
NOTE
1 This parameter is rewritten by the built-in macro data in
FROM at power-up or at a reload operation.
2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built-in
macro data in FROM is used.
- 359-
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3610EN/01
4.58
PARAMETERS OF
OPERATION
12801 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (01)
HISTORY
12802 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {02)
12803 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {03)
12804 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (04)
12805 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (05)
12806 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {06)
12807 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {07)
12808 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {08)
12809 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {09)
1281 O Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {10)
12811 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {11)
12812 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {12)
12813 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {13)
12814 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {14)
12815 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {15)
12816 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {16)
12817 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {17)
12818 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {18)
12819 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {19)
12820 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal {20)
- 360-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
- 361 -
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS 1Hi3S10EN/01
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
112881 RB? RBS RBS RB4 RB3 RB2 RB1 RBO
11
History record bit settings for an operation history signal (01)
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
112882 II RB?
I RBS
I RBS
I RB4
I RB3
I RB2 RB1 RBO
- 362-
1Hi3610EN/01 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
112896 II RB7 RB6 RBS RB4 RB3 RB2 RB1 RBO
- 363 -
APPENDIX
B--63610EN/01 APPENDIX A. CHARACTER CODE LIST
- 367 -
!Hi361 OEN/01 Index
[C] Parameters of Data Server, 33
Parameters of DI/DO, 113
Character Code list, 367
Parameters of Displaying Operation Time and Num-
ber of Parts, 293
Parameters of DNCl lnterface, 28
[D] Parameters of DNCl/DNC2 Interface, 21
Description of Parameters, 7 Parameters of Ethernet, 35
Displaying Parameters, I Parameters of External Data Input/Output, 279
Parameters of Factolink, 31
Parameters of Feedrate, 61
[I] Parameters of Graphic Color, 291
lnpotting and Outputting Parameters Through the Parameters of Graphic Display, 289
Reader/Puncher Interface, 4
Parameters of Graphic Display/Dynamic Graphic Dis-
lnpotting Parameters through the Reader/Puncher In- play, 289
terface, 6
Parameters of High-Speed Machining (High-Speed
Remote Buffer), 320
Parameters of Indexing Index Table, 256
[O] Parameters of Maintenance, 355
Other Parameters, 349 Parameters of Manual Handle Feed and Handle Inter-
Outputting Parameters through the Reader/Puncher ruption, 309
Interface, 5 Parameters of Manual line and Arc Functions, 312
Parameters of Manual Operation and Automatic Op-
eration, 307
[P] Parameters of MDI, Display, and Edit, 117
Parameter of Canned Cycle for Drilling, 216 Parameters of Normal Direction Control, 252
Parameter of Memory Card Interface, 30 Parameters of Operation History, 360
Parameter of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle, 222 Parameters of Pattern Data Input, 266
Parameter of Thread Cutting Cycle, 222 Parameters of Peck Drilling Cycle of a Small Diarne-
ter, 224
Parameters Common to all Channels, 15
Parameters of Pitch Error Compensation, 153
Parameters of Acceleration/ Deceleration Control, 72
Parameters of Polygon Turning, 322
Parameters of Angular Axis Control, 334
Parameters of Position Switch Functions, 303
Parameters of Automatic Tool Compensation (T Se-
ries) and Automatic Tool Length Compensation (M Parameters of Positioning by Optimum Acceleration,
Series), 277 267
Parameters of Axis Control by PMC, 328 Parameters of Power Mate CNC Manager, 36
Parameters of Axis Control/ Increment System, 37 Parameters of Program Restart, 319
Parameters of B-Axis Control, 336 Parameters of Programs, 144
Parameters of Built-in Macro, 356 Parameters of Reader/Puncher Interface, Remote
Buffer, DNCI, DNC2, and M-net Interface, 14
Parameters of Canned Cycles, 216
Parameters of Reference Position Setting with Me-
Parameters of Channel I (110 CHANNEL=O), 16 chanical Stopper, 313
Parameters of Channel I (110 CHANNEL=!), 17 Parameters of Remote Diagnosis, 24
Parameters of Channel 2 (1/0 CHANNEL=2), 18 Parameters of Retracing by the Manual Handle, 280
Parameters of Channel 3 (1/0 CHANNEL=3), 18 Parameters of Rigid Tapping, 228
Parameters of Check Termination, 348 Parameters of Scaling/Coordinate Rotation, 249
Parameters of Coordinates, 46 Parameters of Servo, 88
Parameters of Custom Macros, 258 Parameters of Setting , 9
i-1
Index EH;3610EN/01
i-2
'
J!l
c:
$c:
0
(.)
Z'
~
r
~
..J
~
z
c
:;
IC
w
ti
*
Cl
1. :;
:
IC
~
If
.-
c:
.o
"O
w
f m
"jj ..J
"f w
IC ?
:;
I
~
..l
~
.,~
~
r ~
$
c:
~ 0
(.)
z
~
5
~ "
1U
Cl
"'
~
c:
0
5 ;...
"O
w
FAMJCLTD
Printed In Japan